索尼SONY DVP-K380音响电路原理图
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
SERVICE MANUAL
CD/DVD PLAYER
SPECIFICATIONS
Photo : DVP-K380
RMT-D145E
Hong Kong Model
Taiwan Model
Singapore Model
RMT-D145E
System
Laser: Semiconductor laser
Signal format system: NTSC/PAL
(See Page 1-4 to switch)
Audio characteristics
Frequency response: DVD VIDEO (PCM 96
kHz): 2 Hz to 44 kHz (±1.0 dB)/DVD
VIDEO (PCM 48 kHz): 2 Hz to 22 kHz
(±0.5 dB)/CD: 2 Hz to 20 kHz (±0.5 dB)
Signal-to-noise ratio (S/N ratio): 115 dB
(LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2 jacks only)
Harmonic distortion: 0.003%
Dynamic range: DVD VIDEO: 103 dB/CD: 99
dB
Wow and flutter: Less than detected value
(±0.001% W PEAK)
The signals from LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2
jacks are measured. When you play PCM
sound tracks with a 96 kHz sampling
frequency, the output signals from the
DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or COAXIAL)
jack are converted to 48 kHz sampling
frequency.
Outputs and Input
(Jack name: Jack type/Output level/ Load
impedance)
LINE OUT (AUDIO) 1/2: Phono jack/2 Vrms/
10 kilohms
DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL): optical output
jack/-18dBm (wave length:660nm)
DIGITAL OUT (COAXIAL): Phono jack/ 0.5
Vp-p/75 ohms
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT (Y, CB, CR):
Phono jack/Y: 1.0 Vp-p, CB, CR:
0.7 Vp-p/75 ohms
LINE OUT (VIDEO) 1/2: Phono jack/
1.0 Vp-p 75 ohms
S VIDEO OUT: 4-pin mini DIN/Y:
1.0 Vp-p, C: 0.3 Vp-p(PAL),
0.286 Vp-p(NTSC)/75 ohms
MIC: Phone jack
General
Power requirements:
220-240 V AC, 50/60 Hz
110V AC, 60 Hz
See page 1-1 for further information.
Power consumption: 11 W/ 13 W
See page 1-1 for further information.
Dimensions (approx.):
430 × 74 × 260 mm (width/ height/depth)
incl. projecting parts
Mass (approx.): 2.5 kg
Operating temperature: 5°C to 35°C
Operating humidity: 25% to 80%
Supplied accessories
Check that you have the following items:
• Audio/video cord
( pinplug ××××× 3 y pinplug ××××× 3) (1)
• Remote commander (remote) (1)
• Size AA (R6) batteries (2)
Specifications and design are subject to change
without notice.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 2 —
SAFETY-RELATED COMPONENT WARNING!!
COMPONENTS IDENTIFIED BY MARK
OR DOTTED LINE WITH
MARK
ON THE SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS AND IN THE PARTS
LIST ARE CRITICAL TO SAFE OPERATION. REPLACE THESE
COMPONENTS WITH SONY PARTS WHOSE PART NUMBERS
APPEAR AS SHOWN IN THIS MANUAL OR IN SUPPLEMENTS
PUBLISHED BY SONY.
1.
Check the area of your repair for unsoldered or poorly-soldered
connections. Check the entire board surface for solder splashes
and bridges.
2.
Check the interboard wiring to ensure that no wires are
"pinched" or contact high-wattage resistors.
3.
Look for unauthorized replacement parts, particularly
transistors, that were installed during a previous repair. Point
them out to the customer and recommend their replacement.
4.
Look for parts which, through functioning, show obvious signs
of deterioration. Point them out to the customer and
recommend their replacement.
5.
Check the line cord for cracks and abrasian. Recommend the
replacement of any such line cord to the customer.
6.
Check the B+ voltage to see it is at the values specified.
7.
Flexible Circuit Board Repairing
• Keep the temperature of the soldering iron around 270°C
during repairing.
• Do not touch the soldering iron on the same conductor of the
circuit board (within 3 times).
• Be careful not to apply force on the conductor when soldering
or unsoldering.
SAFETY CHECK-OUT
After correcting the original service problem, perform the following
safety checks before releasing the set to the customer.
LEAKAGE TEST
The AC leakage from any exposed metal part to earth ground
and from all exposed metal parts to any exposed metal part having a
return to chassis, must not exceed 0.5 mA (500 microamperes).
Leakage current can be measured by any one of three methods.
1.
A commercial leakage tester, such as the Simpson 229 or RCA
WT-540A. Follow the manufacturers' instructions to use these
instruments.
2.
A battery-operated AC milliammeter. The Data Precision 245
digital multimeter is suitable for this job.
3.
Measuring the voltage drop across a resistor by means of a VOM
or battery-operated AC voltmeter. The “limit” indication is
0.75V, so analog meters must have an accurate low-voltage scale.
The Simpson 250 and Sanwa SH-63Trd are examples of a
passive VOM that is suitable. Nearly all battery operated digital
multimeters that have a 2V AC range are suitable. (See Fig. A)
Fig. A.
Using an AC voltmeter to check AC leakage.
1.5 kΩ
0.15 µF
AC
voltmeter
(0.75 V)
To Exposed Metal
Parts on Set
Earth Ground
WARNING!!
WHEN SERVICING, DO NOT APPROACH THE LASER EXIT WITH
THE EYE TOO CLOSELY. IN CASE IT IS NECESSARY TO CONFIRM
LASER BEAM EMISSION, BE SURE TO OBSERVE FROM A
DISTANCE OF MORE THAN 25 cm FROM THE SURFACE OF THE
OBJECTIVE LENS ON THE OPTICAL PICK-UP BLOCK.
CAUTION:
The use of optical instrument with this product will increase eye
hazard.
Unleaded solder
Boards requiring use of unleaded solder are printed with the lead-
free mark (LF) indicating the solder contains no lead.
(Caution: Some printed circuit boards may not come printed with
the lead free mark due to their particular size.)
: LEAD FREE MARK
Unleaded solder has the following characteristics.
• Unleaded solder melts at a temperature about 40°C higher than
ordinary solder.
Ordinary soldering irons can be used but the iron tip has to be
applied to the solder joint for a slightly longer time.
Soldering irons using a temperature regulator should be set to
about 350°C.
Caution: The printed pattern (copper foil) may peel away if the
heated tip is applied for too long, so be careful!
• Strong viscosity
Unleaded solder is more viscous (sticky, less prone to flow) than
ordinary solder so use caution not to let solder bridges occur such
as on IC pins, etc.
• Usable with ordinary solder
It is best to use only unleaded solder but unleaded solder may
also be added to ordinary solder.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 3 —
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SERVICE NOTE
1.
DISC REMOVAL PROCEDURE (at POWER OFF)......... 5
2.
HOW TO SERVICE MB-103 BOARD .............................. 5
3.
CONNECTION OF SERVICE JIG .................................... 7
1.
GENERAL
WARNING ............................................................................1-1
Welcome! ...............................................................................1-1
Precautions.............................................................................1-1
About this Manual .................................................................1-1
This Player Can Play the Following Discs ............................1-1
Notes about the Discs ............................................................1-1
Index to Parts and Controls ....................................................1-2
Guide to the Control Menu Display.......................................1-3
Hookups.....................................................................................1-3
Hooking Up the Player ..........................................................1-3
Step 1: Unpacking..................................................................1-3
Step 2: Inserting Batteries into the Remote ...........................1-3
Step 3: Connecting the Video Cords ......................................1-4
Step 4: Connecting the Audio Cords .....................................1-4
Step 5: Connecting the Power Cord .......................................1-5
Step 6: Quick Setup ...............................................................1-5
Playing Discs .............................................................................1-6
Playing Discs .........................................................................1-6
Resuming Playback from the Point Where You Stopped the
Disc (Multi-disc Resume) ..................................................1-7
Using the DVD’s Menu .........................................................1-7
Playing VIDEO CDs with PBC Functions
(PBC Playback) ..................................................................1-7
Playing an MP3 Audio Track .................................................1-7
Various Play Mode Functions (Programme Play, Shuffle Play,
Repeat Play, A-B Repeat Play) ..........................................1-8
Searching for a Scene ................................................................1-9
Searching for a Particular Point a Disc (Search, Scan, Slow-
motion Play, Freeze Frame) ...............................................1-9
Searching for a Title/Chapter/Track/Index/Scene ..................1-9
Searching by Scene (PICTURE NAVIGATION) ................1-10
Enjoying Karaoke ....................................................................1-10
Using Karaoke .....................................................................1-10
Selecting the Vocals (Vocal Select) ......................................1-10
Viewing Information About the Disc.......................................1-11
Checking the Playing Time and Remaining Time ...............1-11
Checking the Play Information ............................................1-11
Sound Adjustments ..................................................................1-12
Changing the Sound.............................................................1-12
TV Virtual Surround Settings (TVS) ...................................1-12
Enjoying Movies......................................................................1-13
Changing the Angles ............................................................1-13
Displaying the Subtitles .......................................................1-13
Adjusting the Picture Quality (BNR) ..................................1-13
Adjusting the Playback Picture (CUSTOM PICTURE MODE) . 1-13
Enhancing the Playback Picture (DIGITAL VIDEO
ENHANCER) ...............................................................1-13
Using Various Additional Functions ........................................1-14
Locking Discs (CUSTOM PARENTAL CONTROL,
PARENTAL CONTROL) .............................................1-14
Controlling Your TV or AV Amplifier (Receiver) with the
Supplied Remote ...........................................................1-15
Settings and Adjustments ........................................................1-15
Using the Setup Display ......................................................1-15
Setting the Display or Sound Track Language
(LANGUAGE SETUP) .................................................1-16
Settings for the Display (SCREEN SETUP) .......................1-16
Custom Settings (CUSTOM SETUP)..................................1-16
Settings for the Sound (AUDIO SETUP) ............................1-17
Additional Information ............................................................1-17
Troubleshooting ...................................................................1-17
Self-diagnosis Function (When letters/numbers appear in the
display).............................................................................1-18
Glossary ...............................................................................1-18
Language Code List .............................................................1-18
2.
DISASSEMBLY
2-1.
CASE, TRAY COVER ASSEMBLY ..............................2-2
2-2.
FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLY .........................................2-2
2-3.
MECHANISM DECK .....................................................2-3
2-4.
OPTICAL PICK-UP (KHM-270AAA)...........................2-3
2-5.
DC-MOTOR, MS-81T BOARD......................................2-4
2-6.
MB-103KM (GA) BOARD .............................................2-4
2-7.
AV-63KM (GA) BOARD ................................................2-5
2-8.
POWER BLOCK.............................................................2-5
2-9.
IF-092KM (GA) BOARD ...............................................2-6
2-10. MC-139 BOARD .............................................................2-6
2-11. INTERNAL VIEWS ........................................................2-7
2-12. CIRCUIT BOARDS LOCATION ...................................2-8
3.
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
3-1.
OVERALL BLOCK DIAGRAM ....................................3-1
3-2.
RF/SERVO BLOCK DIAGRAM ....................................3-3
3-3.
SIGNAL PROCESSOR BLOCK DIAGRAM ................3-5
3-4.
SYSTEM CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM ...................3-7
3-5.
VIDEO BLOCK DIAGRAM ..........................................3-9
3-6.
AUDIO BLOCK DIAGRAM ........................................3-11
3-7.
INTERFACE CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM ...........3-13
3-8.
POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM (1/3) ..............................3-15
3-9.
POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM (2/3) ..............................3-17
3-10. POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM (3/3) ..............................3-19
4.
PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
4-1.
FRAME SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM................................4-1
4-2.
PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC
DIAGRAM ...................................................................4-4
• MS-81 (LOADING)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD AND
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ..............................4-5
• MB-103 (DVD/CD RF AMP, DIGITAL SERVO,
MOTOR DRIVE, SERVO, AV DECODER, SDRAM,
SYSTEM CONTROL, AUDIO DAC, PLL)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD .........................4-7
• MB-103 (DVD/CD RF AMP, DIGITAL SERVO) (1/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-11
• MB-103 (MOTOR DRIVE) (2/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-13
• MB-103 (SERVO) (3/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-15
• MB-103 (AV DECODER) (4/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-17
• MB-103 (SDRAM) (5/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-19
• MB-103 (SYSTEM CONTROL) (6/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-21
• MB-103 (AUDIO DAC, PLL) (7/7)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-23
• AV-063 (AUDIO OUT, VIDEO OUT)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD .......................4-25
• AV-063 (AUDIO OUT) (1/2)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-27
• AV-063 (VIDEO OUT) (2/2)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-29
• IF-092 (IF COM)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD .......................4-31
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 4 —
• IF-092 (IF COM)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-33
• MC-139 (MIC AMP)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD .......................4-35
• MC-139 (MIC AMP)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-37
• ETXNY381N2F (SWITCHING REGULATOR)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD .......................4-39
• HS11S1U (SWITCHING REGULATOR)
PRINTED WIRING BOARD .......................4-41
• ETXNY381N2F (SWITCHING REGULATOR)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-43
• HS11S1U (SWITCHING REGULATOR)
SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM ............................4-45
5.
IC PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
5-1.
SYSTEM CONTROL PIN FUNCTION
(MB-103 BOARD IC104: MB91307RPFV-G-BND-E1) . 5-1
6.
TEST MODE
6-1.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION ...........................................6-1
6-2.
STARTING TEST MODE...............................................6-1
6-3.
SYSCON DIAGNOSIS ...................................................6-1
6-4.
DRIVE AUTO ADJUSTMENT ......................................6-5
6-5.
DRIVE MANUAL OPERATION ...................................6-7
6-6.
MECHA AGING ...........................................................6-11
6-7.
EMERGENCY HISTORY ............................................6-11
6-8.
VERSION INFORMATION .........................................6-11
6-9.
VIDEO LEVEL ADJUSTMENT ..................................6-11
6-10. IF CON SELF DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION .................6-12
6-11. TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................6-18
7.
ELECTRICAL ADJUSTMENT
7-1.
POWER SUPPLY CHECK .............................................7-1
7-2.
ADJUSTMENT OF VIDEO SYSTEM ...........................7-2
1.
Video Level Adjustment (MB-103 BOARD) ..................7-2
2.
Checking S Video Output S-Y .........................................7-2
3.
Checking S Video Output S-C .........................................7-2
4.
Checking Component Video Output Y ............................7-2
5.
Checking Component Video Output B-Y ........................7-3
6.
Checking Component Video Output R-Y ........................7-3
7-3.
ADJUSTMENT RELATED PARTS ARRANGEMENT . 7-4
8.
REPAIR PARTS LIST
8-1.
EXPLODED VIEWS ......................................................8-1
8-1-1.FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLY .........................................8-1
8-1-2.CHASSIS ASSEMBLY ...................................................8-2
8-1-3.MECHANISM DECK ASSEMBLY ...............................8-3
8-2.
ELECTRICAL PARTS LIST ..........................................8-4
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 5 —
SERVICE NOTE
1.
DISC REMOVAL PROCEDURE (at POWER OFF)
1)
Insert a driver into the aperture of the unit bottom, and move the lever of chuck cam in the direction of the arrow A. (See Fig. 1)
2)
Draw out the tray in the direction of the arrow B, and remove a disc. (See Fig. 1)
2.
HOW TO SERVICE MB-103 BOARD
• Jig
1)
Remove the upper case from the set. (Refer to section 2-1)
2)
Remove the MB-103 board. (Refer to section 2-6)
3)
Set the MB-103 board in the stand (with CK-121 board) as
shown in Fig. 2.
Fig. 1.
Fig. 2.
B
A
Aperture
Lever of chuck cam
Tray
FFC 26P J-6090-117-A,
FFC 9P J-6090-118-A,
FFC 5P J-6090-119-A,
FFC 15P J-6090-121-A,
FFC 25P J-6090-122-A
Harness 6P (J-6090-126-A)
CK-120 board
(J-6090-127-A)
CK-122 board
(J-6090-129-A)
Stand
(CK-121 board)
(J-6090-132-A)
Five flexible flat cables
3 Connector (CN101)
5 Connector (CN601)
2 Stand
(with CK-121 board)
1 MB-103 board
6 CK-122 board
4 Two tapping
screws (3 x 6)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 6 —
4)
Set the CK-120 board in the place where the MB-103 board is removed, as shown in Fig. 3.
5)
Set the four flexible flat cables as shown in Fig. 4.
Fig. 4.
Fig. 5.
Fig. 3.
2 Connector
(CN114)
4 Harness (6P: CN110)
4 Harness (6P: CN102)
1 Flexible flat cable
(FFC 25P: CN301 (CK-122 board))
6)
Set the flexible flat cable and the harness as shown in Fig. 5.
7)
Set is finished.
5 Harness
(CN109, 6P)
2 Four tapping screws
(3 × 6)
1 CK-120 board
3 Flexible flat cable (FMO-001)
(CN101, 26P)
4 Flexible flat cable (FMO-002)
(CN103, 9P)
6 Flexible flat cable (FMM-035)
(CN105, 5P)
8 Connector
(CN111, 9P)
7 Connector
(CN113, 25P)
7 Connector (CN102)
4 Connector
(CN106)
6 Connector
(CN112)
5 Connector
(CN104)
2 Flexible flat cable
(FFC 9P: CN204)
3 Flexible flat cable
(FFC 5P: CN201)
8 Flexible flat cable
(FFC 15P: CN202 (CK-121 board))
1 Flexible flat cable
(FFC 26P: CN203)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 7 —
3.
CONNECTION OF SERVICE JIG
CK-120
BOARD
Mechanism deck
IF-92 BOARD
CK-122 BOARD
CK-121 BOARD
(Stand)
B to B Connector 9P
B to B Connector 9P
B to B Connector 25P
B to B Connector 25P
FFC26P
(Used the set)
FFC 9P
(Used the set)
FFC 5P
(Used the set)
HARNESS 6P
HARNESS 5P
(Used the set)
FFC26P
FFC25P
FFC 9P
FFC 5P
HARNESS 6P
FFC15P
CN101
CN102
CN113
CN114
CN103
CN104
CN105
CN106
CN203
CN301
CN204
CN201
CN110
CN102
CN109
CN403
CN404
MC-139
BOARD
MB-103 BOARD
CN501
CN112
CN111
CN201
CN202
CN101
CN601
CN302
AV-63 BOARD
CN204
CN203
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
— 8 —
MEMO
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-1
SECTION 1
GENERAL
DVP-K380
This section is extracted from instruction
manual. (DVP-K380 : 3-082-863-11)
3
Precautions
On safety
• Caution – The use of optical instruments
with this product will increase eye hazard.
• Should any solid object or liquid fall into
the cabinet, unplug the player and have it
checked by qualified personnel before
operating it any further.
On power sources
• The player is not disconnected from the AC
power source (mains) as long as it is
connected to the wall outlet, even if the
player itself has been turned off.
• If you are not going to use the player for a
long time, be sure to disconnect the player
from the wall outlet. To disconnect the AC
power cord (mains lead), grasp the plug
itself; never pull the cord.
On placement
• Place the player in a location with adequate
ventilation to prevent heat build-up in the
player.
• Do not place the player on a soft surface
such as a rug that might block the
ventilation holes.
• Do not place the player in a location near
heat sources, or in a place subject to direct
sunlight, excessive dust, or mechanical
shock.
On operation
• If the player is brought directly from a cold
to a warm location, or is placed in a very
damp room, moisture may condense on the
lenses inside the player. Should this occur,
the player may not operate properly. In this
case, remove the disc and leave the player
turned on for about half an hour until the
moisture evaporates.
• When you move the player, take out any
discs. If you don’t, the disc may be
damaged.
On adjusting volume
Do not turn up the volume while listening to
a section with very low level inputs or no
audio signals. If you do, the speakers may be
damaged when a peak level section is played.
On cleaning
Clean the cabinet, panel, and controls with a
soft cloth slightly moistened with a mild
detergent solution. Do not use any type of
abrasive pad, scouring powder or solvent
such as alcohol or benzine.
On cleaning discs
Do not use a commercially available cleaning
disc. It may cause a malfunction.
If you have any questions or problems
concerning your player, please consult your
nearest Sony dealer.
IMPORTANT NOTICE
Caution: This player is capable of holding a
still video image or on-screen display image
on your television screen indefinitely. If
you leave the still video image or on-screen
display image displayed on your TV for an
extended period of time you risk permanent
damage to your television screen. Plasma
Display Panel television and projection
televisions are susceptible to this.
7
Notes
• Notes about DVD-RWs/DVD-Rs,
DVD+RWs/DVD+Rs or CD-Rs/CD-RWs
Some DVD-RWs/DVD-Rs, DVD+RWs/
DVD+Rs, or CD-Rs/CD-RWs cannot be
played on this player due to the recording
quality or physical condition of the disc, or
the characteristics of the recording device
and authoring software. The disc will not
play if it has not been correctly finalized.
For more information, see the operating
instructions for the recording device. Note
that discs created in the Packet Write format
cannot be played.
• Music dics encoded with copyright
protection technologies
This product is designed to playback discs
that conform to the Compact Disc (CD)
standard. Recently, various music disc
encoded with copyright protection
technologies are marketed by some record
companies. Please be aware that among
those discs, there are some that do not
conform to the CD standard and may not be
playable by this product.
Note on playback operations of
DVDs and VIDEO CDs
Some playback operations of DVDs and
VIDEO CDs may be intentionally set by
software producers. Since this player plays
DVDs and VIDEO CDs according to the disc
contents the software producers designed,
some playback features may not be available.
Also, refer to the instructions supplied with
the DVDs or VIDEO CDs.
Copyrights
This product incorporates copyright
protection technology that is protected by
method claims of certain U.S. patents, other
intellectual property rights owned by
Macrovision Corporation, and other rights
owners. Use of this copyright protection
technology must be authorized by
Macrovision Corporation, and is intended for
home and other limited viewing uses only
unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision
Corporation. Reverse engineering or
disassembly is prohibited.
Notes about the Discs
• To keep the disc clean, handle the disc by its
edge. Do not touch the surface.
• Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight or
heat sources such as hot air ducts, or leave it
in a car parked in direct sunlight as the
temperature may rise considerably inside
the car.
• After playing, store the disc in its case.
• Clean the disc with a cleaning cloth.
Wipe the disc from the centre out.
• Do not use solvents such as benzine,
thinner, commercially available cleaners, or
anti-static spray intended for vinyl LPs.
2
WARNING
To prevent fire or shock
hazard, do not expose the
unit to rain or moisture.
To avoid electrical shock, do
not open the cabinet. Refer
servicing to qualified
personnel only.
The mains lead must only be
changed at a qualified
service shop.
CAUTION
The use of optical instruments with
this product will increase eye
hazard. As the laser beam used in
this CD/DVD player is harmful to
eyes, do not attempt to disassemble
the cabinet.
Refer servicing to qualified
personnel only.
Precautions
Safety
• The power requirements and
power consumption of this unit
are indicated on the back of the
unit. Check that the unit’s
operating voltage is identical
with your local power supply.
• To prevent fire or shock hazard,
do not place objects filled with
liquids, such as vases, on the
apparatus.
Installing
• Do not install the unit in an
inclined position. It is designed
to be operated in a horizontal
position only.
• Keep the unit and discs away
from equipment with strong
magnets, such as microwave
ovens, or large loudspeakers.
• Do not place heavy objects on
the unit.
DVP–XXXX
00V 00Hz
00W
NO.
0-000-000-00
X
Power
requirements
and power
consumption
m
Welcome!
Thank you for purchasing this
Sony CD/DVD Player. Before
operating this player, please read
this manual thoroughly and retain
it for future reference.
6
About this Manual
• Instructions in this manual describe the
controls on the remote. You can also use the
controls on the player if they have the same
or similar names as those on the remote.
• Displays on the screen are slightly different
depending upon where the model is sold.
• The meaning of the icons used in this
manual is described below:
* MP3 (MPEG 1 Audio Layer 3) is a standard
format defined by ISO/MPEG which compresses
audio data.
This Player Can Play the
Following Discs
The “DVD VIDEO” logo is a trademark.
Region code
Your player has a region code printed on the
back of the unit and only will play DVD
VIDEO discs (playback only) labelled with
identical region codes. This system is used to
protect copyrights.
DVDs labelled
will also play on this
player.
If you try to play any other DVD, the message
“Playback prohibited by area limitations.”
will appear on the TV screen. Depending on
the DVD, no region code indication may be
labelled even though playing the DVD is
prohibited by area restrictions.
Example of discs that the player
cannot play
The player cannot play the following discs:
• All CD-ROMs (including PHOTO CDs)/
CD-Rs/CD-RWs other than those recorded
in the following formats:
–music CD format
–video CD format
–MP3 format that conforms to ISO9660*
Level 1/Level 2, or its extended format,
Joliet
• Data part of CD-Extras
• DVD-RWs in VR mode
• DVD-ROMs
• DVD Audio discs
• HD layer on Super Audio CDs
* A logical format of files and folders on CD-
ROMs defined by ISO (International Standard
Organization).
Also, the player cannot play the following
discs:
• A DVD with a different region code.
• A disc that has a non-standard shape (e.g.,
card, heart).
• A disc with paper or stickers on it.
• A disc that has the adhesive of cellophane
tape or a sticker still left on it.
Icon
Meaning
Functions available for DVD
VIDEOs, and DVD-RWs/
DVD-Rs in video mode or
DVD+RWs/DVD+Rs
Functions available for VIDEO
CDs, Super VCDs, or CD-Rs/
CD-RWs in video CD format
or Super VCD format
Functions available for DATA
CDs (CD-ROMs/CD-Rs/CD-
RWs containing MP3* audio
tracks)
Functions available for music
CDs or CD-Rs/CD-RWs in
music CD format
Format of discs
DVD VIDEO
VIDEO CD
Music CD
ALL
DVP–XXXX
00V 00Hz
00W
NO.
0-000-000-00
X
Region code
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-2
8
Index to Parts and Controls
For more information, refer to the pages indicated in parentheses.
Front panel
A [/1 (on/standby) button/indicator (26)
Lights up in green when the power is on
and lights up in red when the player is in
standby mode.
B MIC (microphone) connector (42)
C MIC (microphone) LEVEL control
(42)
D ECHO LEVEL control (42)
E Disc tray (26)
F A (open/close) button (26)
G ./> (previous/next) buttons (27)
H C/X/x/c ENTER buttons (29)
I TOP MENU button (29)
J MENU button (29) (31)
K O RETURN button (27)
L DISPLAY button (12)
M x (stop) button (27)
N X (pause) button (27)
O H (play) button (26)
P Front panel display (9)
Q
(remote sensor) (15)
R SURROUND button (50)
S PICTURE MODE button (54)
9
Front panel display
When playing back a DVD
When playing back a VIDEO CD with Playback Control (PBC) (30)
When playing back a CD, DATA CD (MP3 audio), or VIDEO CD (without PBC)
Playing time (46)
Disc type
Current audio
signal (49)
Lights up when you can change the angle (52)
Current play
mode (33)
Current audio
signal (49)
Playing status
Current title and chapter (46)
Lights up when the player outputs
the signal in NTSC format
Disc type
Playing time (46)
Lights up when the player outputs
the signal in NTSC format
Current scene (46)
Current play mode (33)
Playing status
Playing time (46)
Disc type
Lights up when
playing MP3
audio tracks (31)
Current play mode (33)
Current track and index (46)
Lights up when the player outputs
the signal in NTSC format
Playing status
,continued
10
Rear panel
A DIGITAL OUT (COAXIAL) jack (20)
(21) (22)
B DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL) jack (20)
(21) (22)
C LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2 jacks
(19) (20) (21)
D LINE OUT (VIDEO) 1/2 jacks (16)
E S VIDEO OUT jack (16)
F COMPONENT VIDEO OUT jacks
(16)
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUT
LINE OUT
S VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
CB
CR
11
Remote
A TV [/1 (on/standby) button (61)
B Z OPEN/CLOSE button (27)
C Number buttons (29)
The number 5 button has a tactile dot.*
D CLEAR button (33)
E SUBTITLE button (52)
F AUDIO button (49)
G REPEAT button (35)
H VOCAL SELECT button (43)
I ./> PREV (previous)/NEXT
buttons (27)
J c
/
C SEARCH/STEP buttons
(38)
K X PAUSE button (27)
L H PLAY button (26)
The H button has a tactile dot.*
M C/X/x/c buttons (29)
N DISPLAY button (12)
O TOP MENU button (29)
P [/1 (on/standby) button (26)
Q VOL (volume) +/– buttons (61)
The + button has a tactile dot.*
R TV/VIDEO button (61)
S ENTER button (performs the same
function as wl)
T TIME/TEXT button (45)
U ANGLE button (52)
V PICTURE NAVI (navigation) button
(40)
W SUR (surround) button (50)
X PICTURE MODE button (54)
Y REPLAY button (27)
Z SEARCH MODE button (39)
wj
m/M
SCAN/SLOW
buttons (38)
wk x STOP button (27)
wl ENTER button (23)
e; O RETURN button (27)
ea MENU button (29) (31)
* Use the tactile dot as a reference when operating
the player.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-3
12
Guide to the Control Menu Display
Use the Control Menu to select a function and to view related information. Press DISPLAY
repeatedly to turn on or change the Control Menu display as follows:
z Hint
You can skip the ADVANCED display by setting
“OFF” under “ADVANCED” in the Control Menu
(page 47).
Control Menu Display
The Control Menu display 1 and 2 will show different items depending on the disc type. For
details about each item, please refer to the pages in the parentheses.
Example: Control Menu display 1 when playing a DVD
* Displays the scene number for VIDEO CDs
(PBC is on), track number for VIDEO CDs/
CDs, album number for DATA CDs.
** Displays the index number for VIDEO CDs/
CDs, MP3 audio track number for DATA CDs.
Control Menu display 1
m
Control Menu display 2 (DVD/VIDEO CD only)
m
ADVANCED display (DVD only, See page 47.)
m
Control Menu display off
,
OFF
1: ENGLISH
2: FRENCH
3: SPANISH
OFF
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
DVD VIDEO
PLAY
Select: Cancel:
SUBTITLE
ENTER
RETURN
Currently playing chapter number**
Playing time
Total number of chapters**
Currently playing title number*
Options
Current setting
Total number of titles*
Playback status
(N Playback,
X Pause,
x Stop, etc.)
Function name of
selected Control
Menu item
Operation message
Selected item
Control
Menu items
Type of disc
being played
13
List of Control Menu Items
Item
Item Name, Function, Relevant Disc Type
TITLE (page 39)/SCENE (page 39)/TRACK (page 39)
Selects the title, scene, or track to be played.
CHAPTER (page 39)/INDEX (page 39)
Selects the chapter or index to be played.
ALBUM (page 31)
Selects the album to be played.
TRACK (page 39)
Selects the track to be played.
INDEX (page 39)
Selects the index to be played.
TIME/TEXT (page 39)
Checks the elapsed time and the remaining playback time.
Input the time code for picture and music searching.
Displays the DVD/CD text or the DATA CD’s track name.
AUDIO (page 49)
Changes the audio setting.
SUBTITLE (page 52)
Displays the subtitles.
Changes the subtitle language.
ANGLE (page 52)
Changes the angle.
TVS (TV Virtual Surround) (page 50)
Selects the surround functions.
ADVANCED (page 47)
Displays the information (bit rate or layer) of the disc currently playing.
PARENTAL CONTROL (page 57)
Set to prohibit playback on this player.
SETUP (page 63)
QUICK Setup (page 23)
Use Quick Setup to choose the desired language of the on-screen display, the aspect
ratio of the TV and the audio output.
CUSTOM Setup
In addition to the Quick Setup setting, you can adjust other various settings.
RESET
Returns the settings in “SETUP” to the default setting.
PROGRAM (page 33)
Selects the title, chapter, or track to play in the order you want.
SHUFFLE (page 35)
Plays the title, chapter, or track in random order.
REPEAT (page 35)
Plays the entire disc (all titles/all tracks/all albums) repeatedly or one title/chapter/
track/album repeatedly.
A-B REPEAT (page 36)
Specifies the parts you want to play repeatedly.
,continued
14
z Hint
The Control Menu icon indicator lights up in green
when you select any item
except “OFF.” (“TVS,” “PROGRAM,”
“SHUFFLE,” “REPEAT,” “A-B REPEAT,”
“BNR,” “DIGITAL VIDEO ENHANCER” only).
The “ANGLE” indicator lights up in green only
when the angles can be changed. The “CUSTOM
PICTURE MODE” indicator lights up in green
when any setting other than “STANDARD” is
selected.
BNR (page 53)
Adjusts the picture quality by reducing the “block noise” or mosaic like patterns that
appear on your TV screen.
CUSTOM PICTURE MODE (page 54)
Adjusts the video signal from the player. You can select the picture quality that best
suits the programme you are watching.
DIGITAL VIDEO ENHANCER (page 55)
Exaggerates the outline of the image to produce a sharper picture.
PICTURE NAVIGATION (page 40)
Divides the screen into 9 subscreens to help you find the scene you want quickly.
t
15
Hookups
Hookups
Hooking Up the Player
Follow Steps 1 to 6 to hook up and adjust the settings of the player.
Notes
• Plug cords securely to prevent unwanted noise.
• Refer to the instructions supplied with the components to be connected.
• You cannot connect this player to a TV that does not have a video input jack.
• Be sure to disconnect the power cord (mains lead) of each component before connecting.
Step 1: Unpacking
Check that you have the following items:
• Audio/video cord (pinplug × 3 y pinplug × 3) (1)
• Remote commander (remote) (1)
• Size R6 (AA) batteries (2)
Step 2: Inserting Batteries into the Remote
You can control the player using the supplied remote. Insert two size R6 (AA) batteries by
matching the 3 and # ends on the batteries to the markings inside the compartment. When
using the remote, point it at the remote sensor
on the player.
Notes
• Do not leave the remote in an extremely hot or humid place.
• Do not drop any foreign object into the remote casing, particularly when replacing the batteries.
• Do not expose the remote sensor to direct light from the sun or a lighting apparatus. Doing so may cause a
malfunction.
• If you do not use the remote for an extended period of time, remove the batteries to avoid possible damage
from battery leakage and corrosion.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-4
16
Step 3: Connecting the Video Cords
Connect this player to your TV monitor, projector, or AV amplifier (receiver) using a video cord.
Select one of the patterns A through C, according to the input jack on your TV monitor,
projector, or AV amplifier (receiver).
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUT
LINE OUT
S VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
CB
CR
B
A
C
INPUT
S VIDEO
CR
CB
Y
COMPONENT
VIDEO IN
VIDEO
AUDIO
INPUT
L
R
l : Signal flow
Component
video cord
(not supplied)
(yellow)
Audio/video
cord (supplied)
TV, projector or AV
amplifier (receiver)
CD/DVD player
TV, projector or AV
amplifier (receiver)
(green)
S VIDEO cord
(not supplied)
TV, projector or AV
amplifier (receiver)
(red)
(blue)
(yellow)
(green)
(blue)
(red)
to LINE OUT (VIDEO)1 or 2
to COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
to S VIDEO OUT
17
Hookups
A If you are connecting to a video input jack
Connect the yellow plug of the audio/video cord (supplied) to the yellow (video) jacks. You will
enjoy standard quality images.
Use the red and white plugs to connect to the audio input jacks (page 19). (Do this if you are
connecting to a TV only.)
B If you are connecting to an S VIDEO input jack
Connect an S VIDEO cord (not supplied). You will enjoy high quality images.
C If you are connecting to a monitor, projector, or AV amplifier (receiver)
having component video input jacks (Y, CB, CR)
Connect the component via the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT jacks using a component video
cord (not supplied) or three video cords (not supplied) of the same kind and length. You will
enjoy accurate colour reproduction and high quality images.
When connecting to a wide screen TV
Depending on the disc, the image may not fit your TV screen. If you want to change the aspect
ratio, please refer to page 65.
To change the colour system
The colour system of the player is set to NTSC or PAL. If the on-screen display of the player
does not appear on the TV, change the colour system of the player (PAL or NTSC) so that a
picture appears on your TV. To change the colour system, hold [/1 down for a few seconds
while pressing X on the player.
Note
Do not connect the player to a VCR. If you pass the player signals via the VCR, you may not receive a clear
image on the TV screen. If your TV only has one audio/video input jack, connect the player to this jack.
Yellow (Video)
White (L)
Red (R)
Yellow (Video)
White (L)
Red (R)
Green
Blue
Red
Green
Blue
Red
VCR
CD/DVD player
TV
Connect
directly
18
Step 4: Connecting the Audio Cords
Refer to the chart below to select the connection that best suits your system. Be sure to also read
the instructions for the components you wish to connect.
Select a connection
Select one of the following connections,
through
.
* Manufactured under license from Dolby
Laboratories. “Dolby,” “Pro Logic,” and the
double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby
Laboratories.
** “DTS” and “DTS Digital Out” are trademarks
of Digital Theater Systems, Inc.
Components to be connected
Connection
Your setup
TV
• Surround effects: TVS DYNAMIC (page 51),
TVS WIDE (page 51)
(page 19)
example
Stereo amplifier (receiver) and two speakers
• Surround effects: TVS STANDARD (page 51)
or
MD deck/DAT deck
• Surround effects: TVS STANDARD (page 51)
(page 20)
example
AV amplifier (receiver) having a Dolby*
Surround (Pro Logic) decoder and 3 to 6
speakers
• Surround effects: Dolby Surround (Pro Logic)
(page 73)
(page 21)
example
AV amplifier (receiver) with a digital input jack
having a Dolby Digital, MPEG audio, or DTS**
decoder and 6 speakers
• Surround effects:
—Dolby Digital (5.1ch) (page 73)
—DTS (5.1ch) (page 73)
—MPEG audio (5.1 ch) (page 73)
(page 22)
example
A
D
A
B
C
D
19
Hookups
Connecting to your TV
This connection will use your TV speakers for sound.
* The yellow plug is used for video signals (page
16).
z Hint
When connecting to a monaural TV, use a stereo-
mono conversion cord (not supplied). Connect the
LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2 jacks to the TV’s
audio input jack.
A
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUT
LINE OUT
S VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
CB
CR
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
LINE OUT
A
TV
l : Signal flow
CD/DVD player
(white)
(red)
Audio/video
cord (supplied)
to audio input
(yellow)
(white)
(red)
(yellow)*
to LINE OUT L/R
(AUDIO) 1 or 2
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-5
20
Connecting to a stereo amplifier (receiver) and 2 speakers/Connecting to
an MD deck or DAT deck
If the stereo amplifier (receiver) has audio input jacks L and R only, use
. If the amplifier
(receiver) has a digital input jack, or when connecting to an MD deck or DAT deck, use
.
In this case, you can also connect the player directly to the MD deck or DAT deck without using
your stereo amplifier (receiver).
B
B-1
B-2
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUT
LINE OUT
S VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
CB
CR
B-2
B-1
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
DIGITAL OUT
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
LINE OUT
CD/DVD player
or
Stereo amplifier (receiver)
MD deck/DAT deck
Front (L)
Front (R)
[Speakers]
(white)
(red)
(red)
(white)
Coaxial digital
cord (not supplied)
Stereo audio cord
(not supplied)
to audio input
to coaxial or optical
digital input
Optical digital cord
(not supplied)
Remove jack cap
before connecting
or
to LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1 or 2
to DIGITAL OUT
(COAXIAL or OPTICAL)
l: Signal flow
21
Hookups
Connecting to an AV amplifier (receiver) having a Dolby Surround (Pro
Logic) decoder and 3 to 6 speakers
You can enjoy the Dolby Surround effects only when playing Dolby Surround audio or multi-
channel audio (Dolby Digital) discs.
If your amplifier (receiver) has L and R audio input jacks only, use
. If your amplifier
(receiver) has a digital input jack, use
.
Note
When connecting 6 speakers, replace the monaural
rear speaker with a center speaker, 2 rear speakers
and a subwoofer.
C
C-1
C-2
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUT
LINE OUT
S VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
CB
CR
C-2
C-1
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
DIGITAL OUT
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
LINE OUT
CD/DVD player
or
Front (R)
Front (L)
Rear (R)
Subwoofer
l: Signal flow
Rear (L)
Amplifier (receiver) with Dolby
Surround decoder
Center
Rear (mono)
Stereo
audio cord (not
supplied)
[Speakers]
Coaxial digital cord
(not supplied)
(red)
(white)
to coaxial or optical digital
input
Optical digital cord
(not supplied)
Remove jack cap
before connecting
[Speakers]
or
to audio input
(white)
(red)
to LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1 or 2
to DIGITAL OUT
(COAXIAL or OPTICAL)
,continued
22
Connecting to an AV amplifier (receiver) with a digital input jack having
a Dolby Digital, MPEG audio or DTS decoder and 6 speakers
This connection will allow you to use the Dolby Digital, MPEG audio or DTS decoder function
of your AV amplifier (receiver). You are unable to enjoy the surround sound effects of this
player.
Note
After you have completed the connection, be sure to
set “DOLBY DIGITAL” to “DOLBY DIGITAL”
and “DTS” to “ON” in Quick Setup (page 24). If
your AV amplifier (receiver) has an MPEG audio
decoder function, set “MPEG” to “MPEG” (page
69).
D
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
R
1
2
L
AUDIO
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUT
LINE OUT
S VIDEO
OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
CB
CR
D
PCM/DTS/MPEG
DOLBY DIGITAL
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
DIGITAL OUT
Front (R)
Front (L)
Rear (R)
AV amplifier (receiver) having
a decoder
Subwoofer
Center
Coaxial digital cord
(not supplied)
Optical digital cord
(not supplied)
Remove jack cap
before connecting
[Speakers]
CD/DVD player
l: Signal flow
[Speakers]
Rear (L)
to optical digital input
or
to coaxial digital
input
to DIGITAL OUT
(COAXIAL or
OPTICAL)
23
Hookups
Step 5: Connecting the Power Cord
Plug the player and TV power cords into an AC outlet (mains).
Step 6: Quick Setup
Follow the steps below to make the minimum number of basic adjustments for using the player.
To skip an adjustment, press >. To return to the previous adjustment, press ..
1 Turn on the TV.
2 Press [/1.
3 Switch the input selector on your
TV so that the signal from the
player appears on the TV screen.
“Press [ENTER] to run QUICK SETUP”
appears at the bottom of the screen. If this
message does not appear, select
“QUICK” under “SETUP” in the Control
Menu to run Quick Setup (page 64).
4 Press ENTER without inserting a
disc.
The Setup Display for selecting the
language used in the on-screen display
appears.
5 Press X/x to select a language.
The player uses the language selected
here to display the menu and subtitles as
well.
6 Press ENTER.
The Setup Display for selecting the
aspect ratio of the TV to be connected
appears.
7 Press X/x to select the setting that
matches your TV type.
N If you have a wide-screen TV or a 4:3
standard TV with a wide-screen mode
• 16:9 (page 65)
N If you have a 4:3 standard TV
• 4:3 LETTER BOX or 4:3 PAN SCAN
(page 65)
8 Press ENTER.
The Setup Display for selecting the type
of jack used to connect your amplifier
(receiver) appears.
./>
X/x
ENTER
[/1
LANGUAGE SETUP
OSD:
MENU:
AUDIO:
SUBTITLE:
CHINESE1
ENGLISH
ENGLISH
CHINESE2
SCREEN SETUP
TV TYPE:
COLOR SYSTEM:
SCREEN SAVER:
16:9
4:3 LETTER BOX
BACKGROUND:
4:3 PAN SCAN
16:9
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-6
24
9 Press X/x to select the type of jack
(if any) you are using to connect to
an amplifier (receiver), then press
ENTER.
Choose the item that matches the audio
connection you selected on pages 19 to
22 (
through
).
• If you connect just a TV and nothing
else, select “NO.” Quick Setup is
finished and connections are complete.
• Select “LINE OUTPUT L/R
(AUDIO).” Quick Setup is finished and
connections are complete.
• Select “DIGITAL OUTPUT.” The Setup
Display for “DOLBY DIGITAL” appears.
10Press X/x to select the type of
Dolby Digital signal you wish to
send to your amplifier (receiver).
Choose the signal that matches the audio
connection you selected on pages 20 to
22 (
through
).
• D-PCM (page 69)
• DOLBY DIGITAL (only if the
amplifier (receiver) has a Dolby Digital
decoder) (page 69)
11Press ENTER.
“DTS” is selected.
12Press X/x to select whether or
not you wish to send a DTS signal
to your amplifier (receiver).
Choose the item that matches the audio
connection you selected on pages 20 to
22 (
through
).
• OFF (page 69)
• ON (only if the amplifier (receiver) has
a DTS decoder) (page 69)
13Press ENTER.
Quick Setup is finished. All connections
and setup operations are complete.
If your AV amplifier (receiver) has an
MPEG audio decoder, adjust the
“MPEG” setting (page 69).
Enjoying the surround sound
effects
To enjoy the surround sound effects of this
player or your amplifier (receiver), set the
following items as described below for the
audio connection you selected on pages 20 to
22 (
through
). Each of these is the
default setting and does not need to be adjusted
when you first connect the player. Refer to
page 63 for using the Setup Display.
Audio Connection (pages 19 to 22)
• No additional settings are needed.
• Set “DOWNMIX” to “DOLBY
SURROUND” (page 68)
YES
NO
Is this player connected to an amplifier
(receiver) ? Select the type of jack you
are using.
LINE OUTPUT L/R (AUDIO)
DIGITAL OUTPUT
A
D
A
B-1
C-1
B-2
C-2
D
B
D
AUDIO SETUP
AUDIO ATT:
AUDIO DRC:
DIGITAL OUT:
DOLBY DIGITAL:
MPEG:
OFF
STANDARD
ON
DOWNMIX:
DOLBY SURROUND
D-PCM
DTS:
DOLBY DIGITAL
D-PCM
B-2
C-2
D
AUDIO SETUP
AUDIO ATT:
AUDIO DRC:
DIGITAL OUT:
DOLBY DIGITAL:
MPEG:
OFF
STANDARD
ON
DOWNMIX:
DOLBY SURROUND
D-PCM
PCM
DTS:
OFF
OFF
ON
B
D
B-2
C-2
D
B
D
A
B-1
C-1
25
Hookups
• If the sound distorts even when the volume
is turned down, set “AUDIO ATT” to “ON”
(page 68)
• Set “DOWNMIX” to “DOLBY
SURROUND” (page 68)
• Set “DIGITAL OUT” to “ON” (page 68)
B-2
C-2
D
26
Playing Discs
Playing Discs
Depending on the DVD or VIDEO CD, some
operations may be different or restricted.
Refer to the operating instructions supplied
with your disc.
1 Turn on your TV.
2 Press [/1.
The player turns on and the power
indicator lights up in green.
3 Switch the input selector on your
TV so that the signal from the
player appears on the TV screen.
N When using an amplifier (receiver)
Turn on the amplifier (receiver) and
select the appropriate channel so that you
can hear sound from the player.
4 Press A on the player, and place a
disc on the disc tray.
5 Press H.
The disc tray closes, and the player starts
playback (continuous play). Adjust the
volume on the TV or the amplifier
(receiver).
Depending on the disc, a menu may
appear on the TV screen. For DVDs, see
page 29. For VIDEO CDs, see page 30.
To turn off the player
Press [/1. The player enters standby mode.
z Hint
The player will turn off automatically whenever
you leave it in stop mode for more than 30 minutes
(Auto Power off function).
Notes on playing DTS sound tracks on a CD
• When playing DTS-encoded CDs,
excessive noise will be heard from the
analog stereo jacks. To avoid possible
damage to the audio system, the consumer
should take proper precautions when the
analog stereo jacks of the player are
connected to an amplification system. To
enjoy DTS Digital Surround™ playback, an
external 5.1-channel decoder system must
be connected to the digital jack of the
player.
• Set the sound to “STEREO” using the
AUDIO button when you play DTS sound
tracks on a CD (page 49).
• Do not play DTS sound tracks without first
connecting the player to an audio
component having a built-in DTS decoder.
The player outputs the DTS signal via the
DIGITAL OUT (COAXIAL or OPTICAL)
jack even if “DTS” in “AUDIO SETUP” is
set to “OFF” in the Setup Display (page 69),
and may affect your ears or cause your
speakers to be damaged.
[/1
H
A
[/1
Z
AUDIO
H
Power
indicator
With the playback side facing down
27
Playing Discs
Notes on playing DTS sound tracks on a
DVD
• DTS audio signals are output only through
the DIGITAL OUT (COAXIAL or
OPTICAL) jack.
• When you play a DVD with DTS sound
tracks, set “DTS” to “ON” in “AUDIO
SETUP” (page 69).
• If you connect the player to audio
equipment without a DTS decoder, do not
set “DTS” to “ON” in “AUDIO SETUP”
(page 69). A loud noise may come out from
the speakers, affecting your ears or causing
the speakers to be damaged.
Additional operations
z Hint
The Replay function is useful when you want to
review a scene or dialog that you missed.
Note
You may not be able to use the Replay function with
some scenes.
Locking the disc tray (Child
Lock)
You can lock the disc tray to prevent children
from opening it.
When the player is in standby mode, press
O RETURN, ENTER, and then [/1 on the
remote.
The player turns on and “LOCKED” appears
on the front panel display.
The Z button on the player or the remote does
not work while the Child Lock is set.
To unlock the disc tray
When the player is in standby mode, press
O RETURN, ENTER, and then [/1 again.
Note
Even if you select “RESET” under “SETUP” in the
Control Menu (page 64), the disc tray remains
locked.
To
Operation
Stop
Press x
Pause
Press X
Resume play after
pause
Press X or H
Go to the next chapter,
track, or scene in
continuous play mode
Press >
Go back to the
previous chapter,
track, or scene in
continuous play mode
Press .
Stop play and remove
the disc
Press Z
Replay the previous
scene (DVD only)
Press REPLAY
Z
./>
H
REPLAY
X
x
ENTER
O RETURN
[/1
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-7
28
Resuming Playback from
the Point Where You
Stopped the Disc (Multi-disc
Resume)
The player stores the point where you stopped
the disc for up to 40 discs and resumes
playback the next time you insert the same
disc. When you store a resume playback point
for the 41st disc, the resume playback point
for the first disc is deleted.
1 While playing a disc, press x to
stop playback.
“RESUME” appears on the front panel
display.
2 Press H.
The player starts playback from the point
where you stopped the disc in Step 1.
z Hints
• To play from the beginning of the disc, press x
twice, then press H.
• For CDs and DATA CDs, the player remembers
the resume playback point for the current disc
unless the disc tray is opened, the AC power cord
(mains lead) is disconnected, or only for DATA
CDs, the player enters standby mode.
Notes
• “MULTI-DISC RESUME” in “CUSTOM
SETUP” must be set to “ON” (default) for this
function to work (page 67).
• The resume playback point for the current disc is
cleared when:
– you change the play mode.
– you change the settings on the Setup Display.
• Resume Play does not work during Shuffle Play
and Programme Play.
• This function may not work with some discs.
• If “MULTI-DISC RESUME” in “CUSTOM
SETUP” is set to “ON” and you playback a
recorded disc such as DVD-RW, the player may
playback other recorded discs from the same
resume point. To play from the beginning, press
x twice and then press H.
H
x
29
Playing Discs
Using the DVD’s Menu
A DVD is divided into long sections of a
picture or a music feature called “titles.”
When you play a DVD which contains
several titles, you can select the title you want
using the TOP MENU button.
When you play DVDs that allow you to select
items such as the language for the subtitles
and the language for the sound, select these
items using the MENU button.
1 Press TOP MENU or MENU.
The disc’s menu appears on the TV
screen.
The contents of the menu vary from disc
to disc.
2 Press C/X/x/c or the number
buttons to select the item you want
to play or change.
If you press the number buttons, the
following display appears.
Press the number buttons to select the
item you want.
3 Press ENTER.
z Hint
The disc’s menu also appears when the TOP MENU
or MENU button on the player is pressed.
Number
buttons
ENTER
MENU
TOP MENU
C/X/x/c
1
30
Playing VIDEO CDs with
PBC Functions (PBC Playback)
PBC (Playback Control) allows you to play
VIDEO CDs interactively by following the
menu on the TV screen.
1 Start playing a VIDEO CD with PBC
functions.
The menu for your selection appears.
2 Select the item number you want
by pressing X/x or the number
buttons.
3 Press ENTER.
4 Follow the instructions in the
menu for interactive operations.
Refer to the instructions supplied with the
disc, as the operating procedure may
differ depending on the VIDEO CD.
To return to the menu
Press O RETURN.
z Hint
To play without using PBC, press ./> or the
number buttons while the player is stopped to select
a track, then press H or ENTER.
“Play without PBC” appears on the TV screen and
the player starts continuous play. You cannot play
still pictures such as a menu.
To return to PBC playback, press x twice then
press H.
Notes
• Depending on the VIDEO CD, “Press ENTER” in
Step 3 may appear as “Press SELECT” in the
instructions supplied with the disc. In this case,
press H.
• The PBC functions of Super VCDs do not work
with this player. Super VCDs are played in
continuous play mode only.
Number
buttons
H
x
ENTER
O
RETURN
./>
X/x
31
Playing Discs
Playing an MP3 Audio
Track
You can play back DATA CDs (CD-ROMs/
CD-Rs/CD-RWs) recorded in MP3 (MPEG1
Audio Layer 3) format.
1 Press Z and place a DATA CD on
the disc tray.
2 Press H.
The disc tray closes, and the player starts
to play the first MP3 audio track in the
first album on the disc.
Notes
• The player can play MP3 audio tracks recorded in
the following sampling frequencies: 32kHz,
44.1kHz, 48kHz.
• The playback order may be different from the
edited order. See “The Playback order of MP3
audio tracks” on the next page for details.
Selecting an album and track
1 Press MENU.
The list of MP3 albums recorded on the
DATA CD appears.
2 Select an album using X/x and
press ENTER.
The list of tracks contained in the album
appears.
3 Select a track using X/x and press
ENTER.
The selected track starts playing.
When a track or album is being played, its
title is shaded.
To go to the next or previous page
Press c or C.
To return to the previous display
Press O RETURN.
To turn off the display
Press MENU.
Notes
• Only the letters in the alphabet and numbers can
be used for album or track names. Anything else
is displayed as “*.”
• ID3 tags cannot be displayed.
About MP3 audio tracks
You can play MP3 audio tracks on CD-
ROMs, CD-Rs, or CD-RWs. However, the
discs must be recorded according to ISO9660
level 1, level 2, or Joliet format for the player
to recognize the tracks.
You can also play discs recorded in Multi
Session.
Z
H
ENTER
O RETURN
MENU
C/X/x/c
1 ( 3 0 )
R O C K B E S T H I T
K A R A O K E
J A Z Z
R & B
M Y F A V O R I T E S O N G S
C L A S S I C A L
S A L S A O F C U B A
B O S S A N O V A
J A Z Z
1 ( 9 0 )
0 1 S H E I S S P E C I A L
0 2 A L L Y O U N E E D I S . . .
0 3 S P I C Y L I F E
0 4 H A P P Y H O U R
0 5 R I V E R S I D E
0 6 5
0 7 T A K E T I M E , T A K E T I M E
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-8
32
See the instructions of the CD-R/RW device
or recording software (not supplied) for
details on the recording format.
To play a Multi Session CD
This player can play Multi Session CDs when
an MP3 audio track is located in the first
session. Any subsequent MP3 audio tracks,
recorded in the later sessions, can also be
played back.
When audio tracks and images in music CD
format or video CD format are recorded in the
first session, only the first session will be
played back.
Notes
• If you put the extension “.MP3” to data not in
MP3 format, the player cannot recognize the data
properly and will generate a loud noise which
could damage your speaker system.
• The player cannot play audio tracks in MP3PRO
format.
The Playback order of MP3 audio tracks
The playback order of albums and tracks
recorded on a DATA CD is as follows.
NStructure of disc contents
When you insert a DATA CD and press H,
the numbered tracks are played sequentially,
from 1 through 7. Any sub-albums/tracks
contained within a currently selected album
take priority over the next album in the same
tree. (Example: C contains D so 4 is played
before 5.)
When you press MENU and the list of MP3
albums appears (page 31), the albums are
arranged in the following order: A t B t
C t D t F t G. Albums that do not
contain tracks (such as album E) do not
appear in the list.
z Hints
• If you add numbers (01, 02, 03, etc.) to the front
of the track file names, the tracks will be played in
that order.
• Since a disc with many trees takes longer to start
playback, it is recommended that you create
albums of no more than two trees.
Notes
• Depending on the software you use to create the
DATA CD, the playback order may differ from
the illustration above.
• The playback order above may not be applicable
if there are more than a total of 200 albums and
tracks in the DATA CD.
• The player can recognize up to 100 albums (the
player will count just albums, including albums
that do not contain MP3 audio tracks). The player
will not play any albums beyond the first 100
albums. Of the first 100 albums, the player will
play no more than a combined total of 200 albums
and tracks.
ROOT
Tree 1
Tree 2
Tree 3
Tree 4
Tree 5
album
track
33
Playing Discs
Various Play Mode
Functions (Programme Play,
Shuffle Play, Repeat Play, A-B Repeat
Play)
You can set the following play modes:
• Programme Play (page 33)
• Shuffle Play (page 35)
• Repeat Play (page 35)
• A-B Repeat Play (page 36)
Note
The play mode is cancelled when:
– you open the disc tray.
– the player enters standby mode by pressing [/1.
Creating your own programme
(Programme Play)
You can play the contents of a disc in the
order you want by arranging the order of the
titles, chapters, or tracks on the disc to create
your own programme. You can programme
up to 99 titles, chapters, and tracks.
1 Press DISPLAY twice (when playing a
CD, press once).
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(PROGRAM), then press ENTER.
The options for “PROGRAM” appear.
3 Press X/x to select “SET t,” then
press ENTER.
4 Press c.
The cursor moves to the title or track row
“T” (in this case, “01”).
5 Select the title, chapter, or track you
want to programme.
N When playing a DVD
For example, select chapter “03” of title
“02.”
Press X/x or the number buttons to select
“02” under “T,” then press ENTER.
X/x/c
DISPLAY
ENTER
CLEAR
Number
buttons
H
OFF
OFF
SET
ON
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
DVD VIDEO
PLAY
PROGRAM
1. TITLE
ALL CLEAR
2. TITLE – –
3. TITLE – –
4. TITLE – –
5. TITLE – –
6. TITLE – –
7. TITLE – –
T
– –
01
02
03
04
05
“TRACK” is displayed when you play
a VIDEO CD or CD.
Titles or tracks
recorded on a disc
PROGRAM
1. TITLE – –
ALL CLEAR
2. TITLE – –
3. TITLE – –
4. TITLE – –
5. TITLE – –
6. TITLE – –
7. TITLE – –
T
C
ALL
01
02
03
04
05
06
– –
02
03
04
05
01
Chapters recorded on a disc
,continued
34
Next, press X/x or the number buttons to
select “03” under “C,” then press
ENTER.
N When playing a VIDEO CD or CD
For example, select track “02.”
Press X/x or the number buttons to select
“02” under “T,” then press ENTER.
6 To programme other titles, chapters,
or tracks, repeat Steps 4 to 5.
The programmed titles, chapters, and
tracks are displayed in the selected order.
7 Press H to start Programme Play.
Programme Play begins.
When the programme ends, you can
restart the same programme again by
pressing H.
To return to normal play
Press CLEAR, or select “OFF” in Step 3. To
play the same programme again, select “ON”
in Step 3 and press ENTER.
To turn off the display
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the display
is turned off.
To change or cancel a programme
1
Follow Steps 1 and 3 of “Creating your
own programme (Programme Play).”
2
Select the programme number of the title,
chapter, or track you want to change or
cancel using X/x or the number buttons,
and press c.
3
Follow Step 5 for new programming. To
cancel a programme, select “--” under
“T,” then press ENTER.
To cancel all the titles, chapters, or tracks
in the programmed order
1
Follow Steps 1 through 3 of “Creating
your own programme (Programme
Play).”
2
Press X and select “ALL CLEAR.”
3
Press ENTER.
z Hint
You can do Repeat Play or Shuffle Play of the
programmed titles, chapters, or tracks. During
Programme Play, follow the steps of “Repeat Play”
(page 35) or “Shuffle Play” (page 35).
Notes
• When playing Super VCDs, the total time of the
programmed tracks does not appear on the screen.
• You cannot use this function with VIDEO CDs
with PBC playback.
PROGRAM
1. TITLE – –
ALL CLEAR
2. TITLE – –
3. TITLE – –
4. TITLE – –
5. TITLE – –
6. TITLE – –
7. TITLE – –
C
ALL
03
04
05
06
T
– –
01
02
03
04
05
02
01
T
– –
01
02
03
04
05
PROGRAM
1. TITLE 0 2 – 0 3
ALL CLEAR
2. TITLE – –
3. TITLE – –
4. TITLE – –
5. TITLE – –
6. TITLE – –
7. TITLE – –
Selected title and chapter
PROGRAM
1. TRACK 0 2
ALL CLEAR
2. TRACK – –
3. TRACK – –
4. TRACK – –
5. TRACK – –
6. TRACK – –
7. TRACK – –
0:15:30
– –
01
02
03
04
05
T
Selected track
Total time of the programmed tracks
35
Playing Discs
Playing in random order (Shuffle
Play)
You can have the player “shuffle” titles,
chapters, or tracks. Subsequent “shuffling”
may produce a different playing order.
1 Press DISPLAY twice during playback
(when playing a CD, press once).
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(SHUFFLE), then press ENTER.
The options for “SHUFFLE” appear.
3 Press X/x to select the item to be
shuffled.
N When playing a DVD
• TITLE
• CHAPTER
N When playing a VIDEO CD or CD
• TRACK
N When Programme Play is activated
• ON: shuffles titles, chapters, or tracks
selected in Programme Play.
4 Press ENTER.
Shuffle Play starts.
To return to normal play
Press CLEAR, or select “OFF” in Step 3.
To turn off the Control Menu
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the Control
Menu is turned off.
z Hints
• You can set Shuffle Play while the player is
stopped. After selecting the “SHUFFLE” option,
press H. Shuffle Play starts.
• Up to 200 chapters in a disc can be played in
random order when “CHAPTER” is selected.
Note
You cannot use this function with VIDEO CDs with
PBC playback.
Playing repeatedly (Repeat Play)
You can play all of the titles or tracks on a
disc or a single title, chapter, or track
repeatedly.
You can use a combination of Shuffle or
Programme Play modes.
1 Press REPEAT during playback.
The following display appears.
DISPLAY
ENTER
CLEAR
H
X/x
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
OFF
CHAPTER
TITLE
OFF
DVD VIDEO
PLAY
REPEAT
CLEAR
H
DISC
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-9
36
2 Press REPEAT repeatedly to select the
item to be repeated.
N When playing a DVD
• DISC: repeats all of the titles.
• TITLE: repeats the current title on a
disc.
• CHAPTER: repeats the current
chapter.
N When playing a VIDEO CD or CD
• DISC: repeats all of the tracks.
• TRACK: repeats the current track.
N When playing a DATA CD (MP3 audio)
• DISC: repeats all of the albums.
• ALBUM: repeats the current album.
• TRACK: repeats the current track.
N When Programme Play or Shuffle Play
is activated
• ON: repeats Programme Play or
Shuffle Play.
To return to normal play
Press CLEAR, or select “OFF” in Step 2.
z Hints
• You can set Repeat Play while the player is
stopped. After selecting the “REPEAT” option,
press H. Repeat Play starts.
• You can also select “REPEAT” from the Control
Menu (page 12).
Note
You cannot use this function with VIDEO CDs with
PBC playback.
Repeating a specific portion (A-
B Repeat Play)
You can play a specific portion of a title,
chapter or track repeatedly. (This function is
useful when you want to memorize lyrics, etc.)
1 Press DISPLAY twice during playback
(when playing a CD, press once).
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(A-B
REPEAT), then press ENTER.
The options for “A-B REPEAT”
appear.
3 Press X/x to select “SET t,” then
press ENTER.
The “A-B REPEAT” setting display
appears.
DISPLAY
ENTER
X/x
CLEAR
SET
OFF
OFF
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
DVD VIDEO
PLAY
Set point A with .
A-B REPEAT
ENTER
37
Playing Discs
4 During playback, when you find the
starting point (point A) of the portion to
be played repeatedly, press ENTER.
The starting point (point A) is set.
5 When you reach the ending point
(point B), press ENTER again.
The set points are displayed and the
player starts repeating this specific
portion.
“A-B” appears on the front panel display
during A-B Repeat Play.
To return to normal play
Press CLEAR, or select “OFF” in Step 3.
To turn off the Control Menu
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the Control
Menu is turned off.
Notes
• You can set A-B Repeat Play for only one specific
section.
• When you set A-B Repeat Play, the settings for
Shuffle Play, Repeat Play, and Programme Play
are cancelled.
A: 18 – 1 : 32 : 55
CHAPTER TIME
Set point B with .
ENTER
A-B REPEAT
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
DVD VIDEO
PLAY
A: 18 – 1 : 32 : 55
B: 18 – 1 : 34 : 30
CHAPTER TIME
ON
T 1 : 3 4 : 3 0
38
Searching for a Scene
Searching for a
Particular Point on a
Disc (Search, Scan, Slow-motion
Play, Freeze Frame)
You can quickly locate a particular point on a
disc by monitoring the picture or playing back
slowly.
Note
Depending on the DVD/VIDEO CD, you may not
be able to do some of the operations described.
Locating a point quickly (Search)
During playback, press and hold down
C to locate a point in the playback
direction or press and hold down c
to
locate a point in the opposite direction.
When you find the point you want, release
the button to return to normal playback
speed.
Locating a point quickly by
playing a disc in fast forward or
fast reverse (Scan)
Press
m or M
while playing a
disc. When you find the point you want, press
H to return to normal speed. Each time you
press
m or M
during scan, the
playback speed changes. Three speeds are
available. With each press the indication
changes as shown below. Actual speeds may
differ with some discs.
Playback direction
Opposite direction
The “×2B”/“×2b” playback speed is about
twice the normal speed. The “FF 2M”/“FR
2m” playback speed is faster than “FF
1M”/“FR 1m.”
Watching frame by frame (Slow-
motion play)
Press
m or M
when the player is
in pause mode. To return to the normal speed,
press H.
Each time you press
m or M
during Slow-motion play, the playback speed
changes. Two speeds are available. With each
press the indication changes as follows:
Playback direction
SLOW 2
y SLOW 1
Opposite direction (DVD only)
SLOW 2
y SLOW 1
The “SLOW 2 y”/“SLOW 2
” playback
speed is slower than “SLOW 1 y”/“SLOW
1
.”
Playing one frame at a time
(Freeze Frame)
When the player is in the pause mode, press
C to go to the next frame. Press c
to
go to the preceding frame (DVD only). If you
hold the button down, you can view the
frames in succession. To return to normal
playback, press H.
M
c
/
C
H
m
×2B (DVD/CD only) t FF 1M t FF 2M
×2b (DVD only) t FR 1m t FR 2m
39
Searching for a Scene
Searching for a Title/
Chapter/Track/Index/
Scene
You can search a DVD by title or chapter, and
you can search a VIDEO CD/CD by track,
index, or scene. As titles and tracks are
assigned unique numbers on the disc, you can
select the desired one by entering its number.
Or, you can search for a scene using the time
code.
1 Press SEARCH MODE.
The following display appears.
“-- (**)” appears next to the icon (**
refers to a number).
The number in parentheses indicates the
total number of titles, tracks, indexes,
scenes, etc. of the disc.
2 Press SEARCH MODE repeatedly
to select the search method.
N When playing a DVD
TITLE
CHAPTER
TIME/TEXT
Select “TIME/TEXT” to search for a
starting point by inputting the time code.
N When playing a VIDEO CD without PBC
Playback
TRACK
INDEX
N When playing a VIDEO CD with PBC
Playback
SCENE
INDEX
N When playing a CD
TRACK
INDEX
N When playing a DATA CD (MP3 audio)
ALBUM
TRACK
3 Select the number of the title,
track, scene, time code, etc. you
want by pressing the number
buttons to select the digit.
For example, to find the scene at 2 hours,
10 minutes, and 20 seconds after the
beginning, select “TIME/TEXT” in Step
2 and enter “2:10:20.”
If you make a mistake
Cancel the number by pressing CLEAR,
then select another number.
4 Press ENTER.
The player starts playback from the
selected number.
To turn off the display
Press SEARCH MODE repeatedly until the
display is turned off.
Number
buttons
ENTER
SEARCH
MODE
CLEAR
– –(10)
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-10
40
z Hints
• You can display the first scene of titles, chapters
or tracks recorded on the disc on a screen divided
into 9 sections. You can start playback directly by
selecting one of the scenes. For details, see
“Searching by Scene” (PICTURE
NAVIGATION)” on page 40.
• You can also select “TITLE,” “CHAPTER,”
“TRACK,” “INDEX,” “SCENE,” “TIME/
TEXT,” or “ALBUM” from the Control Menu
(page 12).
• When the Control Menu display is turned off, you
can search for a chapter (DVD) or track (CD) by
pressing the number buttons and ENTER.
Notes
• The title, chapter, or track number displayed is the
same number recorded on the disc.
• You cannot search for a scene on a DVD+RW
using the time code.
Searching by Scene
(PICTURE NAVIGATION)
You can divide the screen into 9 subscreens
and find the desired scene quickly.
1 Press PICTURE NAVI during
playback.
The following display appears.
2 Press PICTURE NAVI repeatedly to
select the item.
Refer to the explanations given for each
item in the following sections.
• TITLE VIEWER (for DVD only)
• CHAPTER VIEWER (for DVD only)
• TRACK VIEWER (for VIDEO CD
only)
• STROBE PLAYBACK
• ANGLE VIEWER (for DVD only)
3 Press ENTER.
ENTER
O RETURN
PICTURE
NAVI
C/X/x/c
X
TITLE VIEWER
ENTER
41
Searching for a Scene
To return to normal play
Press O RETURN.
z Hint
You can also select “PICTURE NAVIGATION”
from the Control Menu (page 12).
Notes
• The “PICTURE NAVIGATION” is not available
when playing Super VCDs.
• Depending on the disc, you may not be able to
select all functions.
• The sound is muted when using this function.
Scanning the title, chapter, or
track (TITLE VIEWER, CHAPTER
VIEWER, TRACK VIEWER)
You can divide the screen into 9 subscreens
and display the first scene of titles, chapters,
or tracks.
You can also play back from the selected title,
chapter, or track. After performing Step 3 of
“Searching by Scene” (PICTURE
NAVIGATION) above, select the scene
using C/X/x/c and press ENTER.
z Hint
If there are more than 9 titles, chapters, or tracks, V
is displayed at the bottom right.
To display the additional titles, chapters, or tracks,
select the bottom right scene (the position 9) and
press x. To return to the previous scene, select the
top left scene (the position 1) and press X.
Dividing a scene into 9 sections
(STROBE PLAYBACK)
You can display 9 consecutive moving
pictures on the screen.
When you press X after performing Step 3 of
“Searching by Scene” above, the moving
pictures pause.
Displaying different angles
simultaneously (ANGLE VIEWER)
If various angles (multi-angles) for a scene
are recorded on the DVD, you can display all
of the angles recorded on the disc on the
screen divided into 9 sections.
You can also play back from the selected
angle. After performing Step 3 of “Searching
by Scene” above, select the angle using C/X/
x/c and press ENTER.
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
42
Enjoying Karaoke
Using Karaoke
You can enjoy karaoke (singing along with a
disc) by connecting a microphone (not
supplied) to the player.
Adjusting the microphone
1 Set the MIC LEVEL control of the MIC
connector to MIN.
2 Plug a microphone (not supplied) into
the MIC connector.
3 Set the ON/OFF switch on the
microphone to ON and turn the MIC
LEVEL control to adjust the
microphone volume.
4 Turn the ECHO LEVEL control to adjust
the echo.
z Hint
If howling occurs:
– move the microphone away from the speakers.
– lower the MIC LEVEL or ECHO LEVEL.
– lower the overall volume.
Note
The sound input from the microphone is not output
from the DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL and
COAXIAL) connectors.
Dolby Digital Karaoke format
Dolby Digital format, which reproduces
surround sound using 5 channels, contains the
“Dolby Digital Karaoke” format specialized
for karaoke. In the Dolby Digital Karaoke
format discs, guide melody and guide vocal
tracks are recorded in addition to the
accompaniment.
Speaker output in normal Dolby Digital
format (5 channel surround)
Speaker output in Dolby Digital Karaoke
format
You can check the audio information using
“AUDIO” in the Control Menu display (page
12). When playing a Dolby Digital Karaoke
disc, “9 KARAOKE” appears at the current
audio format (page 49).
MIC connector
MIC LEVEL
control
ECHO LEVEL
control
Microphone
(not supplied)
Front (L)
Center
Front (R)
Rear (L)
Rear (R)
Accompaniment
(L)
Accompaniment
(R)
Guide melody
Guide vocal 1
Guide vocal 2
You can select any of these.
These are output from the
front speakers (L, R).
43
Enjoying Karaoke
Example:
Selecting the Vocals
(Vocal Select)
You can change the guide vocal channel and
select different kinds of vocals.
1 Press VOCAL SELECT during
playback.
The following display appears.
2 Press VOCAL SELECT repeatedly
to select the desired vocal
channel.
The output channel changes as follows.
The default setting is underlined.
N When playing a DVD
KARAOKE
DOLBY DIGITAL 3 / 2
2/0: Recorded only with
accompaniment.
3/0: Recorded with guide
melody.
3/1: Recorded with guide
melody and guide
vocal.
3/2: Recorded with guide
melody and two kinds
of guide vocals.
VOCAL SELECT
1+2
OFF
m
1+2 (Guide vocal 1+2)
m
1 (Guide vocal 1)
m
2 (Guide vocal 2)
,
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-11
44
N When playing a VIDEO CD or CD
N When playing a Super VCD
z Hints
• The channel returns to the default setting when:
– you turn off the power.
– you remove the disc.
• When playing a DVD recorded only with one
kind of guide vocal, select “OFF” or “1.”
Notes
• When playing a DVD, the function works only
with the Dolby Digital Karaoke format.
• If you select a channel other than “OFF” when
playing a DVD, the guide melody is also output.
• Depending on the discs, you may not be able to do
the operations above.
STEREO (The standard stereo
sound)
m
1/L (The sound of the left channel
(monaural))
m
2/R (The sound of the right channel
(monaural))
,
1:STEREO (The stereo sound of the
audio track 1)
m
1:1/L (The sound of the left channel
of the audio track 1 (monaural))
m
1:2/R (The sound of the right
channel of the audio track 1
(monaural))
m
2:STEREO (The stereo sound of
the audio track 2)
m
2:1/L (The sound of the left channel
of the audio track 2 (monaural))
m
2:2/R (The sound of the right
channel of the audio track 2
(monaural))
,
45
Viewing Information About the Disc
Viewing Information About the
Disc
Checking the Playing
Time and Remaining
Time
You can check the playing time and
remaining time of the current title, chapter, or
track. Also, you can check the DVD/CD text
or track name (MP3 audio) recorded on the
disc.
1 Press TIME/TEXT during playback.
The following display appears.
2 Press TIME/TEXT repeatedly to
change the time information.
The display and the kinds of time that you
can change depend on the disc you are
playing.
N When playing a DVD
• T *:*:* (hours:minutes:seconds)
Playing time of the current title
• T–*:*:*
Remaining time of the current title
• C *:*:*
Playing time of the current chapter
• C–*:*:*
Remaining time of the current chapter
N When playing a VIDEO CD (with PBC
functions)
• *:* (minutes:seconds)
Playing time of the current scene
N When playing a VIDEO CD (without
PBC functions) or CD
• T *:* (minutes:seconds)
Playing time of the current track
• T–*:*
Remaining time of the current track
• D *:*
Playing time of the current disc
• D–*:*
Remaining time of the current disc
N When playing a Super VCD
The remaining time cannot be displayed.
• T *:* (minutes:seconds)
Playing time of the current track
N When playing a DATA CD (MP3 audio)
• *:* (minutes:seconds)
Playing time of the current track
To check the DVD/CD text or track and
album names (MP3 audio)
Press TIME/TEXT repeatedly in Step 2 to
display text recorded on the DVD/CD/DATA
CD.
The DVD/CD text appears only when text is
recorded in the disc. You cannot change the
text. If the disc does not contain text, “NO
TEXT” appears.
For DATA CDs, the track and album names
of the MP3 audio track appears (page 48).
TIME/TEXT
PLAY
T 1:01:57
Time
information
BRAHMS SYMPHONY
46
Checking the information on the
front panel display
You can view the time information and text
displayed on the TV screen also on the front
panel display. The information on the front
panel display changes as follows when you
change the time information on your TV
screen.
When playing a DVD
When playing a DATA CD (MP3 audio)
When playing a VIDEO CD (without PBC
functions) or CD
z Hints
• When playing VIDEO CDs with PBC functions,
the scene number and the playing time are
displayed.
• Long text that does not fit in a single line will
scroll across the front panel display.
• You can also check the time information and text
using the Control Menu (page 12).
Notes
• Depending on the type of disc being played, the
DVD/CD text or track name may not be
displayed.
• The player can only display the first level of the
DVD/CD text, such as the disc name or title.
• Playing time of MP3 audio tracks may not be
displayed correctly.
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
Title playing time and the current title
and chapter number
Remaining time of the current title
Playing time and number of the
current chapter
Remaining time of the current
chapter
Text
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
Track name
Playing time and number of the current
track and album
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
TITLE
TRACK
CHAP
INDEX
ANGLE
NTSC
HOUR
MIN
SEC
Track playing time and the current
track and index number
Remaining time of the current track
Remaining time of the disc
Text
Playing time of the disc
47
Viewing Information About the Disc
Checking the Play
Information
You can check information such as the bit
rate or the disc layer that is being played.
Checking the play information of
a DVD (ADVANCED)
1 Press DISPLAY during playback.
The Control Menu is displayed.
2 Press X/x to select
(ADVANCED), then press ENTER.
The options for “ADVANCED” appear.
3 Press X/x to select items.
For each item, please refer to “Displays
of each item.”
• BIT RATE: displays the bit rate.
• LAYER: displays the layer and the
pick-up point.
4 Press ENTER.
To close the ADVANCED window
Select “OFF” in Step 3.
To turn off the Control Menu
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the Control
Menu is turned off.
Displays of each item
By pressing DISPLAY repeatedly, you can
display either “BIT RATE” or “LAYER,”
whichever was selected in “ADVANCED.”
NBIT RATE
When playing MPEG audio sound tracks
Bit rate refers to the amount of video/audio
data per second in a disc. While playing a
disc, an approximate bit rate of the playback
picture is displayed as Mbps (Mega bit per
second) and the audio as kbps (kilo bit per
second). The higher the bit rate, the larger the
amount of data. However, this does not
always mean that you can get higher quality
pictures or sounds.
NLAYER
Indicates the approximate point where the
disc is playing.
If it is a dual-layer DVD, the player indicates
which layer is being read (“Layer 0” or
“Layer 1”).
For details on the layers, see page 73 (DVD).
ENTER
X/x
DISPLAY
TIME/TEXT
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
BIT RATE
DVD VIDEO
BIT RATE
0
5
10
kbps
Mbps
384
OFF
BIT RATE
LAYER
PLAY
BIT RATE
0
5
10
kbps
Mbps
384
Audio
Video
BIT RATE
0
5
10
kbps
Mbps
0
1000
Audio
Video
Appears when the DVD
has dual layers
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-12
48
Checking the play information of
a DATA CD
By pressing TIME/TEXT while playing MP3
audio track on a DATA CD, you can display
the audio bit rate (the amount of data per
second of the current audio).
PLAY
T
17:30
128k
JAZZ
RIVER SIDE
Album name
Track name
Bit rate
49
Sound Adjustments
Sound Adjustments
Changing the Sound
When playing a DVD recorded in multiple
audio formats (PCM, Dolby Digital, MPEG
audio, or DTS), you can change the audio
format. If the DVD is recorded with
multilingual tracks, you can also change the
language.
With CDs, DATA CDs, or VIDEO CDs, you
can select the sound from the right or left
channel and listen to the sound of the selected
channel through both the right and left
speakers. For example, when playing a disc
containing a song with the vocals on the right
channel and the instruments on the left
channel, you can hear the instruments from
both speakers by selecting the left channel.
1 Press AUDIO during playback.
The following display appears.
2 Press AUDIO repeatedly to select
the desired audio signal.
N When playing a DVD
Depending on the DVD, the choice of
language varies.
When 4 digits are displayed, they
indicate a language code. Refer to
“Language Code List” on page 76 to see
which language the code represents.
When the same language is displayed two
or more times, the DVD is recorded in
multiple audio formats.
N When playing a VIDEO CD, CD, or
DATA CD (MP3 audio)
The default setting is underlined.
• STEREO: The standard stereo sound
• 1/L: The sound of the left channel
(monaural)
• 2/R: The sound of the right channel
(monaural)
N When playing a Super VCD
The default setting is underlined.
• 1: STEREO: The stereo sound of the
audio track 1
• 1: 1/L: The sound of the left channel of
the audio track 1 (monaural)
• 1: 2/R: The sound of the right channel
of the audio track 1 (monaural)
• 2: STEREO: The stereo sound of the
audio track 2
• 2: 1/L: The sound of the left channel of
the audio track 2 (monaural)
• 2: 2/R: The sound of the right channel
of the audio track 2 (monaural)
z Hint
You can also select “AUDIO” from the Control
Menu (page 12).
Note
While playing a Super VCD on which the audio
track is not recorded, no sound will come out when
you select “2:STEREO,” “2:1/L,” or “2:2/R.”
Displaying the audio information
of the disc
Press DISPLAY during playback to display
the Control Menu. Select “AUDIO” using
X/x. The channels being played are displayed
on the screen.
AUDIO
X/x
DISPLAY
DISPLAY
1:ENGLISH
50
For example, in Dolby Digital format,
multiple signals ranging from monaural to 5.1
channel signals can be recorded on a DVD.
Depending on the DVD, the number of the
recorded channels may differ.
*“PCM,” “MPEG,” “DTS,” or “DOLBY
DIGITAL” is displayed.
In the case of “DOLBY DIGITAL,” the
channels in the playing track are displayed
by numbers as follows:
For Dolby Digital 5.1 ch:
**The letters in the programme format
display mean the following sound
component:
L:
Front (left)
R:
Front (right)
C:
Centre
LS:
Rear (left)
RS: Rear (right)
S:
Rear (monaural): The rear
component of the Dolby
Surround processed signal and
the Dolby Digital signal
LFE: Low Frequency Effect signal
z Hint
For Dolby Digital 5.1 ch and DTS, “LFE” is always
enclosed in a solid line regardless of the LFE signal
component being output.
Note
If “DTS” is set to “OFF” in “AUDIO SETUP”
(page 69), the DTS track selection option will not
appear on the screen even if the disc contains DTS
tracks.
TV Virtual Surround
Settings (TVS)
When you connect a stereo TV or 2 front
speakers, TVS (TV Virtual Surround) lets
you enjoy surround sound effects by using
sound imaging to create virtual rear speakers
from the sound of the front speakers (L: left,
R: right) without using actual rear speakers.
TVS was developed by Sony to produce
surround sound for home use using just a
stereo TV.
If the player is set up to output the signal from
the DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or
COAXIAL) jack, the surround effect will
only be heard when “DOLBY DIGITAL” is
set to “D-PCM” and “MPEG” is set to
“PCM” in “AUDIO SETUP” (page 69).
1 Press SUR during playback.
The following display appears.
DVD VIDEO
1: ENGLISH
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
L
R
C
DOLBY DIGITAL 3/2.1
PROGRAM FORMAT
LFE
LS
RS
PLAY
Current audio format*
Currently playing program format**
DOLBY DIGITAL 3 / 2 . 1
LFE (Low Frequency
Effect) component 1
Rear component 2
Front component 2+
Center component 1
SUR
TVS DYNAMIC
51
Sound Adjustments
2 Press SUR repeatedly to select
one of the TVS sounds.
Refer to the following explanations given
for each item.
• TVS DYNAMIC
• TVS WIDE
• TVS NIGHT
• TVS STANDARD
To cancel the setting
Select “OFF” in Step 2.
NTVS DYNAMIC
Creates virtual rear speakers from the sound
of the front speakers (L, R) without using
actual rear speakers (shown below).
This mode is effective when the distance
between the front L and R speakers is short,
such as with built-in speakers on a stereo TV.
NTVS WIDE
Creates virtual rear speakers from the sound
of the front speakers (L, R) without using
actual rear speakers. The virtual speakers are
reproduced as shown in the illustration
below.
This mode is effective when the distance
between the front L and R speakers is short,
such as with built-in speakers on a stereo TV.
NTVS NIGHT
Large sounds, such as explosions, are
suppressed, but the quieter sounds are
unaffected. This feature is useful when you
want to hear the dialog and enjoy the
surround sound effects of “TVS WIDE” at
low volume.
NTVS STANDARD
Creates virtual rear speakers from the sound
of the front speakers (L, R) without using
actual rear speakers. The virtual speakers are
reproduced as shown in the illustration
below. Use this setting when you want to use
TVS with 2 separate speakers.
z Hints
• You can also select “TVS” by pressing
SURROUND button on the player.
• You can also select “TVS” from the Control
Menu (page 12).
Notes
• When the playing signal does not contain a signal
for the rear speakers, the surround effects cannot
be heard.
• When you select one of the TVS modes, turn off
the surround setting of the connected TV or
amplifier (receiver).
• Make sure that your listening position is between
and at an equal distance from your speakers, and
that the speakers are located in similar
surroundings.
• Not all discs will respond to the “TVS NIGHT”
function in the same way.
• When you use the DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or
COAXIAL) jack to listen to MPEG audio signals
and set “MPEG” to “MPEG” in “AUDIO
SETUP,” no sound will come from your speakers
if you select one of the TVS modes.
TV
TV
L: Front speaker (left)
R: Front speaker (right)
: Virtual speaker
L
R
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-13
52
Enjoying Movies
Changing the Angles
If various angles (multi-angles) for a scene
are recorded on the DVD, “ANGLE” appears
in the front panel display. This means that you
can change the viewing angle.
1 Press ANGLE during playback.
The number of the angle appears on the
display.
2 Press ANGLE repeatedly to select
the angle number.
The scene changes to the selected angle.
z Hints
• You can display all the angles recorded on the
disc on the same screen, and start playback
directly from the chosen angle. The angles are
displayed on a screen divided into 9 sections
(page 40).
• You can also select “ANGLE” from the Control
Menu (page 12).
Note
Depending on the DVD, you may not be able to
change the angles even if multi-angles are recorded
on the DVD.
Displaying the Subtitles
If subtitles are recorded on the discs, you can
change the subtitles or turn them on and off
whenever you want while playing a DVD.
1 Press SUBTITLE during playback.
The following display appears.
2 Press SUBTITLE repeatedly to
select the language.
Depending on the DVD, the choice of
language varies.
When 4 digits are displayed, they
indicate a language code. Refer to
“Language Code List” on page 76 to see
which language the code represents.
To turn off the subtitles
Select “OFF” in Step 2.
z Hint
You can also select “SUBTITLE” from the Control
Menu (page 12).
Note
Depending on the DVD, you may not be able to
change the subtitles even if multilingual subtitles
are recorded on it. You also may not be able to turn
them off.
ANGLE
2
SUBTITLE
1:ENGLISH
53
Enjoying Movies
Adjusting the Picture
Quality (BNR)
The Block Noise Reduction (BNR) function
adjusts the picture quality by reducing the
“block noise” or mosaic like patterns that
appear on your TV screen.
1 Press DISPLAY twice during
playback.
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(BNR),
then press ENTER.
The options for “BNR” appear.
3 Press X/x to select a level.
• 1: reduces the “block noise.”
• 2: reduces the “block noise” more than
1.
• 3: reduces the “block noise” more than
2.
4 Press ENTER.
The disc plays with the setting you
selected.
To cancel the “BNR” setting
Select “OFF” in Step 3.
To turn off the Control Menu
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the Control
Menu is turned off.
Notes
• If the outlines of the images on your screen should
become blurred, set “BNR” to “OFF.”
• Depending on the disc or the scene being played,
there may be no “BNR” effect, or it may be hard
to discern.
ENTER
DISPLAY
X/x
OFF
1
2
3
DVD VIDEO
OFF
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
PLAY
54
Adjusting the Playback
Picture (CUSTOM PICTURE MODE)
You can adjust the video signal of the DVD or
VIDEO CD from the player to obtain the
picture quality you want. Choose the setting
that best suits the programme you are
watching.
When you select “MEMORY,” you can make
further adjustments to each element of the
picture (colour, brightness, etc.).
1 Press PICTURE MODE during
playback.
The following display appears.
2 Press PICTURE MODE repeatedly
to select the setting you want.
The default setting is underlined.
• STANDARD: displays a standard
picture.
• DYNAMIC 1: produces a bold dynamic
picture by increasing the picture
contrast and the colour intensity.
• DYNAMIC 2: produces a more
dynamic picture than DYNAMIC 1 by
further increasing the picture contrast
and the colour intensity.
• CINEMA 1: enhances details in dark
areas by increasing the black level.
• CINEMA 2: White colours become
brighter and black colours become
richer, and the colour contrast is
increased.
• MEMORY: adjusts the picture in
greater detail.
z Hints
• When you watch a movie, “CINEMA 1” or
“CINEMA 2” is recommended.
• The picture can be adjusted by pressing
PICTURE MODE button on the player as well.
• You can also select “CUSTOM PICTURE
MODE” from the Control Menu (page 12).
Adjusting the picture items in
“MEMORY”
You can adjust each element of the picture
individually.
• PICTURE: changes the contrast
• BRIGHTNESS: changes the overall
brightness
• COLOR: makes the colours deeper or
lighter
• HUE: changes the colour balance
1 Press PICTURE MODE repeatedly to
select “MEMORY” and press ENTER.
The “PICTURE” adjustment bar appears.
2 Press C/c to adjust the picture
contrast, then press ENTER.
The adjustment is saved, and
“BRIGHTNESS” adjustment bar
appears.
3 Repeat Step 2 to adjust
“BRIGHTNESS,” “COLOR,” and
“HUE.”
ENTER
PICTURE
MODE
O RETURN
C/X/x/c
DYNAMIC 1
(
)
C 0 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
PICTURE
0
Cancel :
Select :
ENTER
RETURN
55
Enjoying Movies
The Custom Picture Mode display
appears. You can check each adjustment.
To turn off the display
Press O RETURN , or select “RETURN” in
Step 3 and press ENTER.
z Hints
• To reset the picture items to the default values,
press c after Step 3 to select “RESET” and press
ENTER.
• When “PLAYBACK MEMORY” in “CUSTOM
SETUP” is set to “ON,” the player will save a
single setting for up to 40 individual discs.
• If you do not want to save the adjustment in Step
2, you can go to the next picture item by pressing
X/x without saving.
Enhancing the Playback
Picture (DIGITAL VIDEO
ENHANCER)
The Digital Video Enhancer (DVE) function
makes the picture appear clear and crisp by
enhancing the outlines of images on your TV
screen. Also, this function can soften the
images on the screen.
1 Press DISPLAY twice during
playback.
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(DIGITAL VIDEO ENHANCER), then
press ENTER.
The options for “DIGITAL VIDEO
ENHANCER” appear.
C 0 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
PICTURE
BRIGHTNESS
COLOR
HUE
RESET
+1
–3
+3
–1
RETURN
ENTER
DISPLAY
X/x
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
DVD VIDEO
OFF
3
2
1
OFF
SOFT
PLAY
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-14
56
3 Press X/x to select a level.
• 1: enhances the outline.
• 2: enhances the outline more than 1.
• 3: enhances the outline more than 2.
• SOFT: softens the image (DVD only).
4 Press ENTER.
The disc plays with the setting you
selected.
To cancel the “DIGITAL VIDEO
ENHANCER” setting
Select “OFF” in Step 3.
To turn off the Control Menu
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the Control
Menu is turned off.
Note
Depending on the disc or the scene being played,
noise found in the disc may become more apparent.
If this happens, it is recommended that you use the
BNR function (page 53) with the DVE function. If
the condition still does not improve, reduce the
Digital Video Enhancer level, or select “SOFT”
(DVD only) in Step 3 above.
57
Using Various Additional Functions
Using Various Additional
Functions
Locking Discs (CUSTOM
PARENTAL CONTROL, PARENTAL
CONTROL)
You can set two kinds of playback restrictions
for the desired disc.
• Custom Parental Control
You can set playback restrictions so that the
player will not play inappropriate discs.
• Parental Control
Playback of some DVDs can be limited
according to a predetermined level such as
the age of the users. Scenes may be blocked
or replaced with different scenes.
The same password is used for both Parental
Control and Custom Parental Control.
Custom Parental Control
You can set the same Custom Parental
Control password for up to 40 discs. When
you set the 41st-disc, the first disc is
cancelled.
1 Insert the disc you want to lock.
If the disc is playing, press x to stop
playback.
2 Press DISPLAY while the player is in
stop mode.
The Control Menu appears.
3 Press X/x to select
(PARENTAL CONTROL), then press
ENTER.
The options for “PARENTAL
CONTROL” appear.
4 Press X/x to select “ON t,” then
press ENTER.
N If you have not entered a password
The display for registering a new
password appears.
Enter a 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
The display for confirming the password
appears.
N When you have already registered a
password
The display for entering the password
appears.
5 Enter or re-enter your 4-digit password
using the number buttons, then press
ENTER.
“Custom parental control is set.” appears
and then the screen returns to the Control
Menu.
X/x
Number
buttons
ENTER
DISPLAY
x
OFF
PASSWORD
PLAYER
ON
DVD VIDEO
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
STOP
PARENTAL CONTROL
Enter a new 4-digit password, then
press .
ENTER
PARENTAL CONTROL
Enter password, then press .
ENTER
58
To turn off the Custom Parental Control
function
1
Follow Steps 1 through 3 of “Custom
Parental Control.”
2
Press X/x to select “OFF t,” then press
ENTER.
3
Enter your 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
To play a disc for which Custom Parental
Control is set
1
Insert the disc for which Custom Parental
Control is set.
The “CUSTOM PARENTAL
CONTROL” display appears.
2
Enter your 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
The player is ready for playback.
z Hint
If you forget your password, enter the 6-digit
number “199703” using the number buttons when
the “CUSTOM PARENTAL CONTROL” display
asks you for your password, then press ENTER.
The display will ask you to enter a new 4-digit
password.
Note
Once you set Custom Parental Control with a
recorded disc such as a DVD-RW, the display for
entering the password may appear again when you
insert a different recorded disc. Input the password
to play the disc.
Parental Control (limited
playback)
Playback of some DVDs can be limited
according to a predetermined level such as the
age of the users. The “PARENTAL
CONTROL” function allows you to set a
playback limitation level.
1 Press DISPLAY while the player is in
stop mode.
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(PARENTAL CONTROL), then press
ENTER.
The options for “PARENTAL
CONTROL” appear.
3 Press X/x to select “PLAYER t,”
then press ENTER.
N If you have not entered a password
The display for registering a new
password appears.
Enter a 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
The display for confirming the password
appears.
CUSTOM PARENTAL CONTROL
Custom parental control is already
set. To play, enter your password
and press .
ENTER
Number
buttons
X/x
ENTER
DISPLAY
H
OFF
PASSWORD
PLAYER
ON
DVD VIDEO
STOP
1 8 ( 3 4 )
1 2 ( 2 7 )
T 1 : 3 2 : 5 5
PARENTAL CONTROL
Enter a new 4-digit password, then
press .
ENTER
59
Using Various Additional Functions
N When you have already registered a
password
The display for entering the password
appears.
4 Enter or re-enter your 4-digit password
using the number buttons, then press
ENTER.
The display for setting the playback
limitation level appears.
5 Press X/x to select “STANDARD,”
then press ENTER.
The selection items for “STANDARD”
are displayed.
6 Press X/x to select a geographic area
as the playback limitation level, then
press ENTER.
The area is selected.
When you select “OTHERS t,” select
and enter a standard code in the table on
page 60 using the number buttons.
7 Press X/x to select “LEVEL,” then
press ENTER.
The selection items for “LEVEL” are
displayed.
8 Select the level you want using X/x,
then press ENTER.
Parental Control setting is complete.
The lower the value, the stricter the
limitation.
To turn off the Parental Control function
Set “LEVEL” to “OFF” in Step 8.
To play a disc for which Parental Control is
set
1
Insert the disc and press H.
The display for entering your password
appears.
2
Enter your 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
The player starts playback.
z Hint
If you forget your password, remove the disc and
repeat Steps 1 to 3 of “Parental Control (limited
playback).” When you are asked to enter your
password, enter “199703” using the number
buttons, then press ENTER. The display will ask
you to enter a new 4-digit password. After you enter
a new 4-digit password, replace the disc in the
player and press H. When the display for entering
your password appears, enter your new password.
PARENTAL CONTROL
Enter password, then press .
ENTER
PARENTAL CONTROL
LEVEL:
OFF
USA
STANDARD:
PARENTAL CONTROL
LEVEL:
OFF
USA
STANDARD:
USA
OTHERS
PARENTAL CONTROL
LEVEL:
OFF
OFF
STANDARD:
8:
7:
6:
5:
NC17
R
PARENTAL CONTROL
LEVEL:
STANDARD:
USA
4:
PG13
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-15
60
Notes
• When you play discs which do not have the
Parental Control function, playback cannot be
limited on this player.
• Depending on the disc, you may be asked to
change the parental control level while playing
the disc. In this case, enter your password, then
change the level. If the Resume Play mode is
cancelled, the level returns to the previous level.
Area Code
Changing the password
1 Press DISPLAY while the player is in
stop mode.
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(PARENTAL CONTROL), then press
ENTER.
The options for “PARENTAL
CONTROL” appear.
3 Press X/x to select “PASSWORD
t,” then press ENTER.
The display for entering the password
appears.
4 Enter your 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
5 Enter a new 4-digit password using the
number buttons, then press ENTER.
6 To confirm your password, re-enter it
using the number buttons, then press
ENTER.
If you make a mistake entering your
password
Press C before you press ENTER and input
the correct number.
If you make a mistake
Press O RETURN.
To turn off the display
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the display
is turned off.
Standard
Code
number
Argentina
2044
Australia
2047
Austria
2046
Belgium
2057
Brazil
2070
Canada
2079
Chile
2090
China
2092
Denmark
2115
Finland
2165
France
2174
Germany
2109
India
2248
Indonesia
2238
Italy
2254
Japan
2276
Korea
2304
Malaysia
2363
Mexico
2362
Netherlands
2376
New Zealand
2390
Norway
2379
Pakistan
2427
Philippines
2424
Portugal
2436
Russia
2489
Singapore
2501
Spain
2149
Sweden
2499
Switzerland
2086
Thailand
2528
United
Kingdom
2184
Standard
Code
number
61
Using Various Additional Functions
Controlling Your TV or AV
Amplifier (Receiver) with
the Supplied Remote
By adjusting the remote signal, you can
control your TV with the supplied remote.
If you connect the player with an AV
amplifier (receiver), you can control the
volume with the supplied remote.
Notes
• Depending on the unit being connected, you may
not be able to control your TV or AV amplifier
(receiver) using some of the buttons below.
• If you enter a new code number, the code number
previously entered will be erased.
• When you replace the batteries of the remote, the
code number you have set may be reset to the
default setting. Set the appropriate code number
again.
Controlling TVs with the remote
1 Hold down TV [/1, and enter your TV’s
manufacturer’s code (see “Code
numbers of controllable TVs” below)
using the number buttons.
2 Release TV [/1.
The remote is set to perform the
followings:
* Once you set a code number for your AV
amplifier (receiver), the VOL +/– buttons on the
remote control the AV amplifier’s volume only. If
you would rather control the TV’s volume, set the
code number to “90” (default) to control the TV’s
volume again.
Code numbers of controllable TVs
If more than one code number is listed, try
entering them one at a time until you find the
one that works with your TV.
TV [/1
Turns the TV on or off
VOL +/–*
Adjusts the volume of the TV
TV/VIDEO
Switches the TV’s input
source between the TV and
other input sources
TV [/1
VOL +/–
TV/VIDEO
Number
buttons
Manufacturer
Code number
Sony
01(default), 03, 04
Aiwa
32
Akai
68
Blaupunkt
10, 21
Grundig
10, 11
Hitachi
24
JVC
33
LG
06
Loewe
45
Mitsubishi
27, 28, 50
Mivar
09
NEC
66
Nokia
15, 16, 69
Orion
47, 48
Panasonic
17, 49
Philips
06, 07, 08
Pioneer
26
Saba
12, 13
Samsung
22, 23
Sanyo
25
Sharp
29
Siemens
39
TEAC
67
Telefunken
36
Thomson
43
Toshiba
38
62
Controlling the volume of your
AV amplifier (receiver) with the
remote
1 Hold down [/1, and enter your AV
amplifier (receiver)’s manufacturer’s
code (see the table below) using the
number buttons.
2 Release [/1.
You can control the volume of the AV
amplifier (receiver) using VOL +/–.
Code numbers of controllable AV
amplifiers (receivers)
If more than one code number is listed, try
entering them one at a time until you find the
one that works with your AV amplifier
(receiver).
If you would rather control the volume of
your TV
Repeat Steps 1 and 2 above and enter the code
number 90 (default).
Manufacturer
Code number
Sony
80, 88, 89, 91
Denon
84, 85, 86
Kenwood
92, 93
Onkyo
81, 82, 83
Pioneer
99
Sansui
87
Technics
97, 98
Yamaha
94, 95, 96
Number
buttons
[/1
VOL +/–
63
Settings and Adjustments
Settings and Adjustments
Using the Setup Display
By using the Setup Display, you can make
various adjustments to items such as picture
and sound. You can also set a language for the
subtitles and the Setup Display, among other
things. For details on each Setup Display
item, see pages from 64 to 69.
Note
Playback settings stored in the disc take priority
over the Setup Display settings and not all the
functions described may work.
1 Press DISPLAY when the player is
in stop mode.
The Control Menu appears.
2 Press X/x to select
(SETUP), then press ENTER.
The options for “SETUP” appear.
3 Press X/x to select “CUSTOM,”
then press ENTER.
The Setup Display appears.
4 Press X/x to select the setup item
from the displayed list:
“LANGUAGE SETUP,” “SCREEN
SETUP,” “CUSTOM SETUP,” or
“AUDIO SETUP.” Then press
ENTER.
The Setup item is selected.
Example: “SCREEN SETUP”
5 Select an item using X/x, then
press ENTER.
The options for the selected item appear.
Example: “TV TYPE”
X/x
ENTER
DISPLAY
( 47 )
: :
QUICK
CUSTOM
RESET
DVD VIDEO
STOP
QUICK
LANGUAGE SETUP
OSD:
MENU:
AUDIO:
SUBTITLE:
ENGLISH
ENGLISH
ORIGINAL
ENGLISH
SCREEN SETUP
TV TYPE:
COLOR SYSTEM:
SCREEN SAVER:
16:9
AUTO
ON
BACKGROUND:
JACKET PICTURE
Selected item
Setup items
SCREEN SETUP
TV TYPE:
COLOR SYSTEM:
SCREEN SAVER:
16:9
4:3 LETTER BOX
BACKGROUND:
4:3 PAN SCAN
16:9
Options
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-16
64
6 Select a setting using X/x, then
press ENTER.
The setting is selected and setup is
complete.
Example: “4:3 PAN SCAN”
To turn off the display
Press DISPLAY repeatedly until the display
is turned off.
To enter the Quick Setup mode
Select “QUICK” in Step 3. Follow from Step
5 of the Quick Setup explanation to make
basic adjustments (page 23).
To reset all of the “SETUP” settings
1
Select “RESET” in Step 3 and press
ENTER.
2
Select “YES” using X/x.
You can also quit the process and return
to the Control Menu by selecting “NO”
here.
3
Press ENTER.
All the settings explained on pages 64 to
69 return to the default settings. Do not
press [/1 while resetting the player as it
takes a few seconds to complete.
Setting the Display or
Sound Track Language
(LANGUAGE SETUP)
“LANGUAGE SETUP” allows you to set
various languages for the on-screen display or
sound track.
Select “LANGUAGE SETUP” in the Setup
Display. To use the display, see “Using the
Setup Display” (page 63).
N OSD (On-Screen Display)
Switches the display language on the screen.
N MENU (DVD only)
You can select the desired language for the
disc’s menu.
N AUDIO (DVD only)
Switches the language of the sound track.
When you select “ORIGINAL,” the language
given priority in the disc is selected.
N SUBTITLE (DVD only)
Switches the language of the subtitle recorded
on the DVD.
When you select “AUDIO FOLLOW,” the
language for the subtitles changes according to
the language you selected for the sound track.
z Hint
If you select “OTHERS t” in “MENU,”
“SUBTITLE,” and “AUDIO,” select and enter a
language code from “Language Code List” on
page 76 using the number buttons.
Note
When you select a language in “MENU,”
“SUBTITLE,” or “AUDIO” that is not recorded on
the DVD, one of the recorded languages will be
automatically selected.
SCREEN SETUP
TV TYPE:
COLOR SYSTEM:
SCREEN SAVER:
4:3 PAN SCAN
AUTO
ON
BACKGROUND:
JACKET PICTURE
Selected setting
LANGUAGE SETUP
OSD:
MENU:
AUDIO:
SUBTITLE:
ENGLISH
ENGLISH
ORIGINAL
ENGLISH
65
Settings and Adjustments
Settings for the Display
(SCREEN SETUP)
Choose settings according to the TV to be
connected.
Select “SCREEN SETUP” in the Setup
Display. To use the display, see “Using the
Setup Display” (page 63).
The default settings are underlined.
N TV TYPE
Selects the aspect ratio of the connected TV
(4:3 standard or wide).
Note
Depending on the DVD, “4:3 LETTER BOX” may
be selected automatically instead of “4:3 PAN
SCAN” or vice versa.
N COLOR SYSTEM (VIDEO CD only)
Select the colour system when you play a
VIDEO CD.
Notes
• You cannot change the colour system for DVDs.
• You can change the colour system of this player
according to the connected TV. See page 17.
N SCREEN SAVER
The screen saver image appears when you
leave the player in pause or stop mode for 15
minutes, or when you play back a CD or
DATA CD (MP3 audio) for more than 15
minutes. The screen saver will help prevent
your display device from becoming damaged
(ghosting). Press H to turn off the screen
saver.
16:9
Select this when you connect a
wide-screen TV or a TV with a
wide mode function.
4:3
LETTER
BOX
Select this when you connect a
4:3 screen TV. Displays a wide
picture with bands on the upper
and lower portions of the
screen.
4:3
PAN SCAN
Select this when you connect a
4:3 screen TV. Automatically
displays the wide picture on the
entire screen and cuts off the
portions that do not fit.
SCREEN SETUP
TV TYPE:
COLOR SYSTEM:
SCREEN SAVER:
16:9
AUTO
ON
BACKGROUND:
JACKET PICTURE
4:3 PAN SCAN
4:3 LETTER BOX
16:9
AUTO
Outputs the video signal in the
system of the VIDEO CD,
either PAL or NTSC. If your
TV is the DUAL system, select
AUTO.
PAL
Changes the video signal of an
NTSC VIDEO CD and outputs
it in the PAL system.
NTSC
Changes the video signal of a
PAL VIDEO CD and outputs it
in the NTSC system.
ON
Turns on the screen saver.
OFF
Turns off the screen saver.
,continued
66
N BACKGROUND
Selects the background colour or picture on
the TV screen in stop mode or while playing
a CD or DATA CD (MP3 audio).
Custom Settings (CUSTOM
SETUP)
Use this to set up playback related and other
settings.
Select “CUSTOM SETUP” in the Setup
Display. To use the display, see “Using the
Setup Display” (page 63).
The default settings are underlined.
N AUTO PLAY
Switches the Auto Play setting on or off. This
function is useful when the player is
connected to a timer (not supplied).
N DIMMER
Adjusts the lighting of the front panel display.
N PAUSE MODE (DVD only)
Selects the picture in pause mode.
JACKET
PICTURE
The jacket picture (still picture)
appears, but only when the
jacket picture is already
recorded on the disc (CD-
EXTRA, etc.). If the disc does
not contain a jacket picture, the
“GRAPHICS” picture appears.
GRAPHICS
A preset picture stored in the
player appears.
BLUE
The background colour is blue.
BLACK
The background colour is black.
OFF
Switches this function off.
ON
Automatically starts playback
when the player is turned on.
BRIGHT
Makes the lighting bright.
DARK
Makes the lighting dark.
OFF
Turns off the lighting.
AUTO
The picture, including subjects
that move dynamically, is
output with no jitter. Normally
select this position.
FRAME
The picture, including subjects
that do not move dynamically,
is output in high resolution.
CUSTOM SETUP
AUTO PLAY:
DIMMER:
PAUSE MODE:
OFF
BRIGHT
AUTO
ON
PLAYBACK MEMORY:
OFF
TRACK SELECTION:
ON
MULTI-DISC RESUME:
67
Settings and Adjustments
N PLAYBACK MEMORY (DVD/VIDEO CD
only)
The player can store the “SUBTITLE” and
other settings of each disc for up to 40 discs
(Playback Memory).
Set this function “ON” or “OFF.”
The following settings are stored in memory.
–ANGLE (page 52)*
–AUDIO (page 49)*
–BNR (page 53)
–DIGITAL VIDEO ENHANCER (page 55)
–SUBTITLE (page 52)*
–CUSTOM PICTURE MODE (page 54)
* DVD only
Note
The player can store the settings of up to 40 discs.
When you store the setting of disc number 41, the
first disc setting is cancelled.
N TRACK SELECTION (DVD only)
Gives the sound track which contains the
highest number of channels priority when you
play a DVD on which multiple audio formats
(PCM, MPEG audio, DTS, or Dolby Digital
format) are recorded.
Notes
• When you set the item to “AUTO,” the language
may change. The “TRACK SELECTION” setting
has higher priority than the “AUDIO” settings in
“LANGUAGE SETUP” (page 64).
• If you set “DTS” to “OFF” (page 69), the DTS
sound track is not played even if you set “TRACK
SELECTION” to “AUTO.”
• If PCM, DTS, MPEG audio, and Dolby Digital
sound tracks have the same number of channels,
the player selects PCM, DTS, Dolby Digital, and
MPEG audio sound tracks in this order.
N MULTI-DISC RESUME (DVD/VIDEO CD
only)
Switches the Multi-disc Resume setting on or
off. Resume playback point can be stored in
memory for up to 40 different DVD/VIDEO
CD discs (page 28).
ON
Stores the settings in memory
when you eject the disc.
OFF
Does not store the settings in
memory.
OFF
No priority given.
AUTO
Priority given.
ON
Stores the resume settings in
memory for up to 40 discs (The
settings remain in memory even
if you select OFF.)
OFF
Does not store the resume
settings in memory. Playback
restarts at the resume point only
for the current disc in the player.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-17
68
Settings for the Sound
(AUDIO SETUP)
“AUDIO SETUP” allows you to set the sound
according to the playback and connection
conditions.
Select “AUDIO SETUP” in the Setup
Display. To use the display, see “Using the
Setup Display” (page 63).
The default settings are underlined.
N AUDIO ATT (attenuation)
If the playback sound is distorted, set this
item to “ON.” The player reduces the audio
output level.
This function affects the output of the LINE
OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2 jacks.
N AUDIO DRC (Dynamic Range Control)
(DVD only)
Makes the sound clear when the volume is
turned down when playing a DVD that
conforms to “AUDIO DRC.” This affects the
output from the following jacks:
–LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2 jacks
–DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or COAXIAL)
jack only when “DOLBY DIGITAL” is set
to “D-PCM” (page 69).
N DOWNMIX (DVD only)
Switches the method for mixing down to 2
channels when you play a DVD which has
rear sound elements (channels) or is recorded
in Dolby Digital format. For details on the
rear signal components, see “Displaying the
audio information of the disc” (page 49). This
function affects the output of the following
jacks:
–LINE OUT L/R (AUDIO) 1/2 jacks
–DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or COAXIAL)
jack when “DOLBY DIGITAL” is set to
“D-PCM” (page 69).
N DIGITAL OUT
Selects if audio signals are output via the
DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or COAXIAL)
jack.
Setting the digital output signal
Switches the method of outputting audio
signals when you connect a component such
as an amplifier (receiver) or MD deck with a
digital input jack.
For connection details, see page 18.
Select “DOLBY DIGITAL,” “MPEG,” and
“DTS” after setting “DIGITAL OUT” to
“ON.”
OFF
Normally, select this position.
ON
Select this when the playback sound
from the speakers is distorted.
STANDARD Normally select this position.
TV MODE
Makes the low sounds clear
even if you turn the volume
down.
WIDE
RANGE
Gives you the feeling of being
at a live performance.
AUDIO SETUP
AUDIO ATT:
AUDIO DRC:
DIGITAL OUT:
OFF
STANDARD
ON
DOWNMIX:
DOLBY SURROUND
DOLBY DIGITAL:
MPEG:
D-PCM
PCM
DTS:
OFF
DOLBY
SUR-
ROUND
Normally, select this position.
Multi-channel audio signals are
output to two channels for
enjoying surround sounds.
NORMAL
Multi-channel audio signals are
downmixed to two channels for
use with your stereo.
ON
Normally select this position. When
you select “ON,” see “Setting the
digital output signal” for further
settings.
OFF
The influence of the digital circuit
upon the analog circuit is minimal.
AUDIO SETUP
AUDIO ATT:
AUDIO DRC:
DOLBY DIGITAL:
MPEG:
OFF
STANDARD
DOWNMIX:
DOLBY SURROUND
D-PCM
PCM
DTS:
OFF
DIGITAL OUT:
ON
69
Settings and Adjustments
If you connect a component that does not
conform to the selected audio signal, a loud
noise (or no sound) will come out from the
speakers, affecting your ears or causing the
speakers to be damaged.
N DOLBY DIGITAL (DVD only)
Selects the type of Dolby Digital signal.
N MPEG (DVD only)
Selects the type of MPEG audio signal.
N DTS (DVD only)
Selects whether or not to output DTS signals.
Note
When you use the DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or
COAXIAL) jack to listen to MPEG audio signals
and set “MPEG” to “MPEG” in “AUDIO SETUP,”
no sound will come from your speakers if you select
one of the TVS modes.
D-PCM
Select this when the player is
connected to an audio
component lacking a built-in
Dolby Digital decoder. You can
select whether the signals
conform to Dolby Surround
(Pro Logic) or not by making
adjustments to the
“DOWNMIX” item in
“AUDIO SETUP” (page 68).
DOLBY
DIGITAL
Select this when the player is
connected to an audio
component with a built-in
Dolby Digital decoder.
PCM
Select this when the player is
connected to an audio
component lacking a built-in
MPEG decoder. If you play
MPEG audio sound tracks, the
player outputs stereo signals
via the DIGITAL OUT
(OPTICAL or COAXIAL)
jack.
MPEG
Select this when the player is
connected to an audio
component with a built-in
MPEG decoder.
OFF
Select this when the player is
connected to an audio
component lacking a built-in
DTS decoder.
ON
Select this when the player is
connected to an audio
component with a built-in DTS
decoder.
70
Additional Information
Troubleshooting
If you experience any of the following
difficulties while using the player, use this
troubleshooting guide to help remedy the
problem before requesting repairs. Should
any problem persist, consult your nearest
Sony dealer.
Power
The power is not turned on.
, Check that the power cord (mains lead) is
connected securely.
Picture
There is no picture/picture noise appears.
, Re-connect the connecting cord securely.
, The connecting cords are damaged.
, Check the connection to your TV (page 16)
and switch the input selector on your TV so
that the signal from the player appears on
the TV screen.
, The disc is dirty or flawed.
, If the picture output from your player goes
through your VCR to get to your TV or if
you are connected to a combination TV/
VIDEO player, the copy-protection signal
applied to some DVD programmes could
affect picture quality. If you still experience
problems even when you connect your
player directly to your TV, please try
connecting your player to your TV’s S
VIDEO input (page 16).
, If the colour system of your player does not
match with that of your TV, change the
colour system of the player. For details, see
page 17. (You cannot change the colour
system of the DVD disc itself.)
Even though you set the aspect ratio in “TV
TYPE” of “SCREEN SETUP,” the picture
does not fill the screen.
, The aspect ratio of the disc is fixed on your
DVD.
Sound
There is no sound.
, Re-connect the connecting cord securely.
, The connecting cord is damaged.
, The player is connected to the wrong input
jack on the amplifier (receiver) (page 20,
21, 22).
, The amplifier (receiver) input is not
correctly set.
, The player is in pause mode or in Slow-
motion Play mode.
, The player is in fast forward or fast reverse
mode.
, If the audio signal does not come through
the DIGITAL OUT (OPTICAL or
COAXIAL) jack, check the audio settings
(page 68).
, While playing a Super VCD on which the
audio track 2 is not recorded, no sound will
come out when you select “2:STEREO,”
“2:1/L,” or “2:2/R.”
Sound is noisy.
, When playing a CD with DTS sound tracks,
noise will come from the LINE OUT L/R
(AUDIO) 1/2 jacks or DIGITAL OUT
(OPTICAL or COAXIAL) jack (page 26).
Sound distortion occurs.
, Set “AUDIO ATT” in “AUDIO SETUP” to
“ON” (page 68).
The sound volume is low.
, The sound volume is low on some DVDs.
The sound volume may improve if you set
“AUDIO DRC” to “TV MODE” (page 68).
, Set “AUDIO ATT” in “AUDIO SETUP” to
“OFF” (page 68).
71
Additional Information
Operation
The remote does not function.
, There are obstacles between the remote and
the player.
, The distance between the remote and the
player is too far.
, The remote is not pointed at the remote
sensor on the player.
, The batteries in the remote are weak.
The disc does not play.
, The disc is turned over.
Insert the disc with the playback side facing
down on the disc tray.
, The disc is skewed.
, The player cannot play certain discs (page 6).
, The region code on the DVD does not match
the player.
, Moisture has condensed inside the player
(page 3).
, The player cannot play a recorded disc that
is not correctly finalized (page 7).
The MP3 audio track cannot be played
(page 31).
, The DATA CD is not recorded in the MP3
format that conforms to ISO9660 Level 1/
Level 2 or Joliet.
, The MP3 audio track does not have the
extension “.MP3.”
, The data is not formatted in MP3 even
though it has the extension “.MP3.”
, The data is not MPEG1 Audio Layer 3 data.
, The player cannot play audio tracks in
MP3PRO format.
The title of the MP3 audio album or track
is not correctly displayed.
, The player can only display numbers and
alphabet. Other characters are displayed as
“*.”
The disc does not start playing from the
beginning.
, Programme Play, Shuffle Play, Repeat Play,
or A-B Repeat Play has been selected (page
33).
, Resume play has taken effect (page 28).
The player starts playing the disc
automatically.
, The disc features an auto playback function.
, “AUTO PLAY” in “CUSTOM SETUP” is
set to “ON” (page 66).
Playback stops automatically.
, While playing discs with an auto pause
signal, the player stops playback at the auto
pause signal.
You cannot perform some functions such
as Stop, Search, Slow-motion Play,
Repeat Play, Shuffle Play, or Programme
Play.
, Depending on the disc, you may not be able
to do some of the operations above. See the
operating manual that comes with the disc.
The language for the sound track cannot
be changed.
, Try using the DVD’s menu instead of the
direct selection button on the remote (page
29).
, Multilingual tracks are not recorded on the
DVD being played.
, The DVD prohibits the changing of the
language for the sound track.
The subtitle language cannot be changed
or turned off.
, Try using the DVD’s menu instead of the
direct selection button on the remote (page
29).
, Multilingual subtitles are not recorded on
the DVD being played.
, The DVD prohibits the changing of the
subtitles.
The angles cannot be changed.
, Try using the DVD’s menu instead of the
direct selection button on the remote (page
29).
, Multi-angles are not recorded on the DVD
being played.
, The angle can only be changed when the
“ANGLE” indicator lights up on the front
panel display (page 9).
, The DVD prohibits changing of the angles.
,continued
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
1-18E
72
The player does not operate properly.
, When static electricity, etc., causes the
player to operate abnormally, unplug the
player.
Nothing is displayed on the front panel
display.
, “DIMMER” in “CUSTOM SETUP” is set
to “OFF.” Set “DIMMER” to “BRIGHT” or
“DARK” (page 66).
5 numbers or letters are displayed on the
screen and on the front panel display.
, The self-diagnosis function was activated.
(See the table on page 72.)
The disc tray does not open and “LOCKED”
appears on the front panel display.
, Child Lock is set (page 27).
The disc tray does not open and “TRAY
LOCKED” appears on the front panel
display.
, Contact your Sony dealer or local
authorized Sony service facility.
“Data error” appears on the TV screen
when playing a DATA CD.
, The MP3 audio track you want to play is
broken.
, The data is not MPEG 1 Audio Layer 3 data.
Self-diagnosis Function
(When letters/numbers appear in the
display)
When the self-diagnosis function is activated
to prevent the player from malfunctioning, a
five-character service number (e.g., C 13 50)
with a combination of a letter and four digits
appears on the screen and the front panel
display. In this case, check the following
table.
First three
characters of
the service
number
Cause and/or corrective
action
C 13
The disc is dirty.
,Clean the disc with a soft
cloth (page 7).
C 31
The disc is not inserted
correctly.
,Re-insert the disc
correctly.
E XX
(xx is a number)
To prevent a malfunction, the
player has performed the
self-diagnosis function.
,Contact your nearest
Sony dealer or local
authorized Sony service
facility and give the 5-
character service number.
Example: E 61 10
C:13:50
73
Additional Information
Glossary
Chapter (page 9)
Sections of a picture or a music feature that
are smaller than titles. A title is composed of
several chapters. Depending on the disc, no
chapters may be recorded.
Dolby Digital (page 22, 69)
Digital audio compression technology
developed by Dolby Laboratories. This
technology conforms to 5.1-channel surround
sound. The rear channel is stereo and there is
a discrete subwoofer channel in this format.
Dolby Digital provides the same 5.1 discrete
channels of high quality digital audio found in
“Dolby Digital” theater surround sound
systems. Good channel separation is realized
because all of the channel data are recorded
discretely and little deterioration is realized
because all channel data processing is digital.
Dolby Surround (Pro Logic) (page 21)
Audio signal processing technology that
Dolby Laboratories developed for surround
sound. When the input signal contains a
surround component, the Pro Logic process
outputs the front, centre and rear signals. The
rear channel is monaural.
DTS (page 22, 69)
Digital audio compression technology that
Digital Theater Systems, Inc. developed. This
technology conforms to 5.1-channel surround
sound. The rear channel is stereo and there is
a discrete subwoofer channel in this format.
DTS provides the same 5.1 discrete channels
of high quality digital audio.
Good channel separation is realized because
all of the channel data is recorded discretely
and little deterioration is realized because all
channel data processing is digital.
DVD (page 6)
A disc that contains up to 8 hours of moving
pictures even though its diameter is the same
as a CD.
The data capacity of a single-layer and single-
sided DVD is 4.7 GB (Giga Byte), which is 7
times that of a CD. The data capacity of a
double-layer and single-sided DVD is 8.5
GB, a single-layer and double-sided DVD is
9.4 GB, and double-layer and double-sided
DVD is 17GB.
The picture data uses the MPEG 2 format, one
of the worldwide standards of digital
compression technology. The picture data is
compressed to about 1/40 (average) of its
original size. The DVD also uses a variable
rate coding technology that changes the data
to be allocated according to the status of the
picture. Audio information is recorded in a
multi-channel format, such as Dolby Digital,
allowing you to enjoy a more real audio
presence.
Furthermore, various advanced functions
such as the multi-angle, multilingual, and
Parental Control functions are provided with
the DVD.
DVD-RW (page 6)
A DVD-RW is a recordable and rewritable
disc that is the same size as a DVD VIDEO.
The DVD-RW has two different modes: VR
mode and Video mode. DVD-RWs created in
Video mode have the same format as a DVD
VIDEO, while discs created in VR (Video
Recording) mode allow the contents to be
programmed or edited.
DVD+RW (page 6)
A DVD+RW (plus RW) is a recordable and
rewritable disc. DVD+RWs use a recording
format that is comparable to the DVD VIDEO
format.
Index (CD)/Video Index (VIDEO CD) (page
9)
A number that divides a track into sections to
easily locate the point you want on a CD or
VIDEO CD. Depending on the disc, no index
may be recorded.
MPEG audio (page 22, 69)
International standard coding system used to
compress audio digital signals authorized by
ISO/IEC. MPEG 1 conforms to up to 2-
channel stereo. MPEG 2, used on DVDs,
conforms to up to 7.1-channel surround.
74
Scene (page 9)
On a VIDEO CD with PBC (playback
control) functions, the menu screens, moving
pictures and still pictures are divided into
sections called “scenes.”
Title (page 9)
The longest section of a picture or music
feature on a DVD, movie, etc., in video
software, or the entire album in audio
software.
Track (page 9)
Sections of a picture or a music feature on a
CD or VIDEO CD (the length of a song).
76
Language Code List
For details, see pages 49, 52, 64.
The language spellings conform to the ISO 639: 1988 (E/F) standard.
Code Language
Code Language
Code Language
Code Language
1027 Afar
1028 Abkhazian
1032 Afrikaans
1039 Amharic
1044 Arabic
1045 Assamese
1051 Aymara
1052 Azerbaijani
1053 Bashkir
1057 Byelorussian
1059 Bulgarian
1060 Bihari
1061 Bislama
1066 Bengali;
Bangla
1067 Tibetan
1070 Breton
1079 Catalan
1093 Corsican
1097 Czech
1103 Welsh
1105 Danish
1109 German
1130 Bhutani
1142 Greek
1144 English
1145 Esperanto
1149 Spanish
1150 Estonian
1151 Basque
1157 Persian
1165 Finnish
1166 Fiji
1171 Faroese
1174 French
1181 Frisian
1183 Irish
1186 Scots Gaelic
1194 Galician
1196 Guarani
1203 Gujarati
1209 Hausa
1217 Hindi
1226 Croatian
1229 Hungarian
1233 Armenian
1235 Interlingua
1239 Interlingue
1245 Inupiak
1248 Indonesian
1253 Icelandic
1254 Italian
1257 Hebrew
1261 Japanese
1269 Yiddish
1283 Javanese
1287 Georgian
1297 Kazakh
1298 Greenlandic
1299 Cambodian
1300 Kannada
1301 Korean
1305 Kashmiri
1307 Kurdish
1311 Kirghiz
1313 Latin
1326 Lingala
1327 Laothian
1332 Lithuanian
1334 Latvian;
Lettish
1345 Malagasy
1347 Maori
1349 Macedonian
1350 Malayalam
1352 Mongolian
1353 Moldavian
1356 Marathi
1357 Malay
1358 Maltese
1363 Burmese
1365 Nauru
1369 Nepali
1376 Dutch
1379 Norwegian
1393 Occitan
1403 (Afan)Oromo
1408 Oriya
1417 Punjabi
1428 Polish
1435 Pashto;
Pushto
1436 Portuguese
1463 Quechua
1481 Rhaeto-
Romance
1482 Kirundi
1483 Romanian
1489 Russian
1491 Kinyarwanda
1495 Sanskrit
1498 Sindhi
1501 Sangho
1502 Serbo-
Croatian
1503 Singhalese
1505 Slovak
1506 Slovenian
1507 Samoan
1508 Shona
1509 Somali
1511 Albanian
1512 Serbian
1513 Siswati
1514 Sesotho
1515 Sundanese
1516 Swedish
1517 Swahili
1521 Tamil
1525 Telugu
1527 Tajik
1528 Thai
1529 Tigrinya
1531 Turkmen
1532 Tagalog
1534 Setswana
1535 Tonga
1538 Turkish
1539 Tsonga
1540 Tatar
1543 Twi
1557 Ukrainian
1564 Urdu
1572 Uzbek
1581 Vietnamese
1587 Volapük
1613 Wolof
1632 Xhosa
1665 Yoruba
1684 Chinese
1697 Zulu
1703 Not specified
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-1
DVP-K380
SECTION 2
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: The following flow chart shows the disassembly procedure.
IF-92KM (GA) boards
(Page 2-6)
Optical pick-up
(KHM-270AAA)
(Page 2-3)
DC-motor,
MS-81T board
(Page 2-4)
Mechanism deck
(Page 2-3)
AV-63KM (GA) board
(Page 2-5)
Front panel assembly
(Page 2-2)
MB-103KM (GA) board
(Page 2-4)
MC-139 board
(Page 2-6)
Power block
(Page 2-5)
Case,
Tray cover assembly
(Page 2-2)
Set
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-2
2-1. CASE, TRAY COVER ASSEMBLY
2-2. FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLY
NOTE: Follow the disassembly procedure in the numerical order given.
B
2 Tapping screw
8 Tray cover
assembly
7 Two claws
4 Case
1 Tapping screw
3 Three tapping screws
A
5 Insert a driver into the aperture of the unit bottom,
and move the lever of chuck cam
in the direction of arrow A.
6 Pull the tray in the
direction of arrow B.
6 Claw
3 Claw
4 Two claws
7 Front panel
assembly
5 Two
claws
2 Tactile switch
(CN406, 5P)
1 Harness
(CN501, 5P)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-3
2-3. MECHANISM DECK
2-4. OPTICAL PICK-UP (KHM-270AAA)
1 Two tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 6)
6 Three tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 6)
7 Mechanism deck
2 Fp support
3 Flexible flat cable (FMO-001)
(CN203, 26P)
4 Flexible flat cable (FMO-002)
(CN204, 9P)
5 Flexible flat cable (FMM-035)
(CN201, 5P)
ESD Protector
3 Flexible flat cable (FMO-001)
(26P)
2 Flexible flat cable (FMO-002)
(9P)
5 Two insulators
4 Insulator
1 Three insulator screws
6 Optical pick-up
(KHM-270AAA)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-4
2-5. DC-MOTOR, MS-81T BOARD
2-6. MB-103KM (GA) BOARD
9 Flexible flat cable (FMM-035)
(CN001, 5P)
7 Remove the
two solderings
q; MS-81T board
1 Two claws
3 Tray
5 Two screws
(+P) (2.6 x 3)
4 Belt
6 Motor pulley
8 DC motor
2
3 Harness
(CN102, 6P)
7 Four tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 6)
8 MB-103KM (GA) board
1 Flexible flat cable (FMO-001)
(CN203, 26P)
2 Flexible flat cable (FMO-002)
(CN204, 9P)
4 Flexible flat cable (FMM-035)
(CN201, 5P)
6 Connector
(CN101, 9P)
5 Connector
(CN601, 25P)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-5
2-7. AV-63KM (GA) BOARD
2-8. POWER BLOCK
5 Six tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 ×10)
1 Connector
(CN601, 25P)
2 Harness
(CN204, 5P)
3 Harness
(CN202, 7P)
6 AV-63KM (GA)
4 Two tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 ×6)
1 Harness
(CN201, 13P)
2 Power cord
(CN101, 2P)
3 Four tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 6)
4 Power block
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-6
2-9. IF-92KM (GA) BOARD
2-10.MC-139 BOARD
1 Harness
(CN202, 7P)
6 IF-92KM (GA) board
3 Harness
(CN201, 13P)
2 Harness
(CN102, 6P)
5 Three tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 6)
4 Connector
(CAN101, 8P)
2 Two tapping screws
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 10)
3 Tapping screw
(+BV Sumitite B3)
(3 × 10)
5 MC-139 board
4 Micjack holder
1 Two volume knobs
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-7
2-11.INTERNAL VIEWS
DC motor
(Loading)
1-763-810-11
DC motor
(Loading)
1-763-810-11
Optical device
(KHM-270AAA/SERVICE ASSY)
A-6062-709-A
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
2-8E
2-12.CIRCUIT BOARDS LOCATION
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
SECTION 3
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
3-1.
OVERALL BLOCK DIAGRAM
3-1
3-2
IC201
IC301
IC403
IC303
IC101
IC601
IC404
IC404,405
IC102
J101 (1/2)
J101 (2/2)
J103
J104
IC202
BASE UNIT
KHM-270AAA/
SERVICE ASSY
MS-81 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-5)
MB-103 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-11 to 4-24)
AV-63 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-27 to 4-30)
IF-92 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-33)
OPTICAL DEVICE
DVD/CD
PD IC
RF
DVD/CD RF AMP,
SERVO ERROR PROCESS
SIGO
ARP,
SERVO DSP
FOCUS
COIL
TRACKING
COIL
FOCUS/TRACKING
COIL DRIVE,
SPINDLE/SLED/
LOADING
MOTOR DRIVE
M
M
M
SPINDLE
MOTOR
SLED
MOTOR
M001
LOADING
MOTOR
FUNCTION
KEY
ND401
FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR TUBE
IF COM
P CON
POWER
SERIAL BUS
EEPROM
PARALLEL BUS
CDDOUT, CDDATA,
CDBCK, CDLRCK
SDI 0 – 7
AV DECODER
SPDIF, ACH12,
ACH34, ACH56,
BCK, LRCK
16M DRAM
16M SDRAM
V, Y, C
Y, Cb, Cr
VIDEO
BUFFER
SPDIF
IC204
AUDIO
D/A CONVERTER
IC201
AUDIO
AMP
EVER+3.3V
+11V
+5V
SW+3.3V
+1.8V
SW+3.3V
+5V
SW+11V
SW–13V
INLIMIT
SENSOR
CHUCK/TRAY
DETECT
SWITCHING REGULATOR
(HS11S1U):Taiwan
(ETXNY381N2F):Others
(SEE PAGE 4-43,4-45)
SWITCHING
REG
AC IN
16
LINE OUT
VIDEO 1
VIDEO 2
S VIDEO OUT
L
R
LINE OUT
AUDIO 2
L
R
AUDIO 1
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
OUT
COAXIAL
J201
D101-104
F101
2A
AI+5V
EVER+3.3V
AU+11V
SW–13V
REG
SW
IC104
IC403
SYSTEM
CONTROL
S001
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
AU+5V
REG
IC106
FLASH
MEMORY
SW801
POWER
Y
C
C
B
R
IC202
AUDIO
AMP
IC503
ECHO
IC501
MIC AMP
IC502
MIC AMP
MC-139 BOARD
J501
MIC
PUSH
ENTER
CURSOR STICK
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-2.
RF/SERVO BLOCK DIAGRAM
3-3
3-4
2
19
25
27
59
42
41
36
38
44
13
15
21
33
37
14
11
7
10
45
48
32
29
125
124
126
147
131
148
152
15
18
37
36
21
22
48
1
47
46
20
22
15
17
35
34
27
28
7
10
25
24
3
4
45
5
128
153
154
146
61
12
11
143 144
32 33
MB-103 BOARD (1/4)
(SEE PAGE 4-11 to 4-16)
BASE UNIT
KHM-270AAA/SERVICE ASSY
OPTICAL DEVICE
24
25
17
16
22
20
13
8
6
12
4
3
15
23
18
26
2
1
Q201
DVD LD DRIVE
IC201
IC301
DVD/CD
PD IC
DVD/CD
LD MODULE
CN203
DVD/CD RF AMP,
DIGITAL SERVO
RF IN
A – D
E – H
A2 – D2
VC
DVDPD
CDPD
DVD LD
SIGO
FE
TE
PI
DFT
MON
MIRR
TZC
SRD
SWD
SCLK
SDEN
SERVO DSP
ADC1
ADC0
ADC2
DFCTI
ADC7
POM 2, 3
129
130 ADC5, 6
MIRR
TZC
ADC4
SIGNAL PROCESSOR
(SEE PAGE 3-5)
SYSTEM CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-7)
XRESET
HCS
HINT
MDSO
MDPO
163 164
GIO9/FGREF
GIO10/FGIN
GIO1/INT3
PWM2
PWM0, 1
POM 0, 1
GIO0/INT2
SPINDLE
MOTOR
DRIVE
FOCUS
COIL
DRIVE
TRACKING
COIL
DRIVE
LOADING
MOTOR
DRIVE
SLED
MOTOR
DRIVE
7
1
4
9
8
1
5
4
IC202
5
2
4
1
2
CN201
CN001
LDM±
CKSW1
OCSW1
INLIMIT
SENSOR
TRACKING
COIL
FOCUS
COIL
M001
LOADING
MOTOR
M
M
M
MS-81 BOARD (SEE PAGE 4-5)
SLED
MOTOR
SPINDLE
MOTOR
CN204
39
VCI
19
39
20
22
16
17
155
GIO2/INT4
16
CHUCK/TRAY
DETECT
S001
(1/2)
RF
A – D
E – H
VC
PD
DVD LD
26
Q202
CD LD DRIVE
CD LD
CD LD
VR
SLA±, SLB±
SPM±
INLIM
TRK±
127 ADC3
FCS±
PS
TSD-M
40
42
43
VREF
+3.3V
LDON
159
161
162
167
GIO6/SDI
GIO7/SDO
GIO8/SCK
GIO13
XSDPIT
XSDPCS
XRST
XDRVMUTE
OCSW1
SIGO
CKSW1
XLDON
FE
TE
PI
SSDFCTI
SS MON
MDSO, MDPO
SPMUTE
SLDA, SLDB
LMP, LMM
TSD
LMCTL
TDRV±
FDRV±
SPFG
SLE
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-5
3-6
3-3.
SIGNAL PROCESSOR BLOCK DIAGRAM
SDCK, XSHD,
XSRQ, XSAK, SDEF
SDCK
XSHD
XSRQ
XSAK
SDEF
DATA
BCLK
LRCK
DOUT
CDIN2I
CDIN1I
CDBCKI
CDLRKI
ICLKI
IERRI
ISTARTI
IVALI
IREQO
111
113
24
25
26
27
28
150
196
197
207
22
70
24
25
63
55
65
61
59
57
26
28
29
166
167
158
160
134
141
2
9
37
40
42
45
169
170
175
56
57
59
63
64
47
51
77
84
65 – 74
MEMA 0 – 9
MEMD 0 – 15
ADAD 0 – 11
ADDT 0 – 15
105-108 110-113
115 116 118 120
135-138 140-143
145-148 150
151 153 154
168-169
171-174
176-179
181-184
186-189
191-194
2 – 5
7 – 10
12 – 15
17 – 20
122 124 125
127 129 130
132 133
36 – 43
46 – 53
29 31
30
IC303
16M DRAM
IC301
ARP
IC403
AV DECODER
IC404,405
16M SDRAM
31
32
34
35
202 – 205
MB-103 BOARD (2/4)
(SEE PAGE 4-15 to 4-20)
SIGO
RF/SERVO
(SEE PAGE 3-4)
SYSTEM CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-7)
16
RFIN1
RFIN2
SD 0 – 7
SDI 0 – 7
DTI 0 – 7
MA 0 – 9
MD 0 – 15
SDDQ 0 – 15
CDDATA, CDBCK,
CDLRCK, CDDOUT
CLK, CKE,
DQML, DQMU,
CS, WE,
CAS, RAS
WE, RAS
LCAS, UCAS
C OUT
Y OUT
COMPOUT
B OUT
R OUT
G OUT
C
Y
V
Cr/B
Cb/R
Y/G
COUT
YOUT
COMPOUT
CR/B
CB/R
Y/G
VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-9)
AUDIO
(SEE PAGE 3-11)
VREFI
ACH12
ACH34
ACH56
LAND
LRCKO
BCKO
ACH12
LRCK
BCK
VIDEO
LEVEL
ADJ
RV401
HD 0 – 15
HAD 0 – 21
HA 0 – 21
HD 0 – 15
D 0 – 7
A 0 – 7
HA 0 – 7
HD 8 – 15
XRD
XWRH
RSTn
DM ACK1
DM REQ1
DM ACK0
DM REQ0
ACLK
HAD23
HAD22
CLKI
SCLKI
200
199
HWAIT0n
HIREQ0
HA 0 – 21
HD 0 – 15
HA 0 – 21
HD 0 – 15
XRST
512FSAVD
33MARP
XWRH
XRD
TRST
XARPIT
XARPCS
XWAIT
XAVDCS2
XAVDCS3
27MAVD
XAVDIT
DREQ0
DACK0
DREQ1
DACK1
XWR
XRD
XINT
XCS
XWAT
CLKIN
30
DO
SPDIF
175
174
173
172
TDO
TCK
TDI
TMS
171
97
99
98
101
102
TRST
TDI
TCK
TDO
TMS
TRST
HCSn
HRWn
LAND
(FOR J TAG)
(2/2)
3
CN601 (1/3)
1
11
7
9
5
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-7
3-8
3-4.
SYSTEM CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM
17
62
67
48
18
57
82
63
56
36
9
15
10
20
76
51
83
7
39
26
27
38
25
7
6
5
70
58
71
46
16
81
47
60
61
49
50
8
7
1 – 5 102 – 109 111 – 118 120
85 – 100
14
MB-103 BOARD (3/4)
(SEE PAGE 4-21 to 4-24)
IC104
SYSTEM
CONTROL
IC103
PLL
IC101
EEPROM
HD 0 – 15
HA 0 – 21
SIGNAL PROCESSOR
(SEE PAGE 3-5)
XARPIT
XARPCS
XWAIT
HA0 – 21
HA1 – 20
HD0 – 15
HD0 – 15
CSOX
SO0
SCO
SI0
INTERFACE
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-13)
SI0
SO0
SC0
XIFCS
XIFBUSY
XFRRST
MAMUTE
XRST
INT4
XFRRST
XIFCS
MAMUTE
48/44.1k
54
53
X101
16.5MHz
XDRVMUTE
INT2
WIDE
CS5X
CKSW1
XDRVMUTE
XSDPIT
OCSW1
XLDON
XSDPCS
CKSW1
DREQ0
INTO
DACK0
CS2X
CS3X
DREQ1
DACK1
DREQ0
XAVDIT
DACK0
XAVDCS2
XAVDCS3
DREQ1
DACK1
VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-9)
SIGNAL PROCESSOR
(SEE PAGE 3-5)
RF/SERVO
(SEE PAGE 3-4)
16
33MARP
512FSAVD
X102
27MHz
33-1OUT
FSEL
512FS2CH
TRST
29
SO1
SO1
30
SC1
SC1
79
XDACS
XDACS
INT1
CS4X
XWAIT
35
XRST
XRST
XRST
XRD
XWRH
512-2OUT
512-1OUT
XTI
XTO
3
27MAVD
27-1OUT
X1
X2
HD 0 – 15
HA 0 – 21
XRD
XWRH
3
CN101
5
6
8
4
1
CN601 (2/3)
2
WP
SCL
SDA
OCSW1
SCL
SDA
WP
WIDE
XARPRST
SI0
SO0
SC0
XIFCS
IFBSY
TRST
WIDE
AUDIO
(SEE PAGE 3-11)
HA 0 – 21
HD 0 – 15
IC106
FLASH
29.5nsec
IC103 qg
3.3Vp-p
IC103 9,q;
40.8nsec
3.3Vp-p
37.4nsec
IC103 8
3.3Vp-p
37.4nsec
IC103 3
3.3Vp-p
60.6nsec
IC104 tf
3.3Vp-p
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-9
3-10
3-5.
VIDEO BLOCK DIAGRAM
3
8
6
29
33
31
7
IC102
VIDEO BUFFER
12
15
17
24
22
20
19
15
25
23
21
17
AV-63 BOARD (1/2)
(SEE PAGE 4-29)
CN203 (1/2)
CN202 (1/2)
V
Y
C
Y/G
Cb/R
Cr/B
WIDE
VMUTE
SIGNAL PROCESSOR
(SEE PAGE 3-6)
16
SYSTEM CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-8)
INTERFACE CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-13)
J101 (1/2)
J103
16
J104
Y
Cb
Cr
LINE OUT
VIDEO 1
VIDEO 2
Y
C
S VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
Y IN
C IN
MUTE1
Y IN
Cb IN
Cr IN
MUTE2
VIDEO OUT
Y OUT
C OUT
Y OUT
Cb OUT
Cr OUT
V
Y
C
Y
Cb
Cr
Q104, 105
WIDE SWITCH
1
24
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
Y
C
C
B
R
IC102 ed PAL
H
H
IC102 ed NTSC
1.9Vp-p
2.5Vp-p
H
IC102 wf,wl NTSC
H
1.9Vp-p
IC102 wf,wl PAL
1.9Vp-p
H
1.4Vp-p
IC102 ea NTSC
H
1.9Vp-p
IC102 ea PAL
H
IC102 ws NTSC
1.0Vp-p
IC102 ws PAL
H
1.4Vp-p
H
H
IC102 w; PAL
IC102 w; NTSC
1.4Vp-p
1.0Vp-p
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-11
3-12
3-6.
AUDIO BLOCK DIAGRAM
3
2
5
6
12
11
10
9
IC201
AUDIO AMP
IC601
AUDIO D/A CONVERTER
9
CN203 (2/2)
SDTI
AOUTL+
AOUTL–
AOUTR+
AOUTR–
16
DZFL
SYSTEM
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-8)
SIGNAL PROCESSOR
(SEE PAGE 3-6)
INTERFACE
CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-13)
ALT+
16
J101 (2/2)
3
BICK
2
LRCK
4
MCLK
1
CSN
6
PDN
5
CCLK
7
CDTI
8
17
CN601 (3/3)
11
ALT–
15
5
ART+
21
3
ART–
23
4
LMUTE
22
2
MAMUTE
24
MB-103 BOARD (4/4)
(SEE PAGE 4-23)
AV-63 BOARD (2/2)
(SEE PAGE 4-27)
10
IC204
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
OUT
COAXIAL
SPDIF
J201
16
CN202 (2/2)
2
SPDIF
1
D IN
ACH12
LRCK
BCK
SO1
SC1
XRST
512FS2CH
XDACS
MAMUTE
D202
Q211
BUFFER
Q208
MUTE
Q207
MUTE
1
7
+
–
+
–
Q202, 204, 205
MUTE DRIVE
L
R
AUDIO 1
LINE OUT
AUDIO 2
R
L
A MUTE
2
6
1
7
IC202
AUDIO AMP
CN204
4
5
Q217
MUTE DRIVE
MC-139 BOARD
6
2
7
1
IC501
MIC AMP
4
5
Q501,502
MUTE DRIVE
MIC + ECHO
MIC
5
2
7
1
IC502
MIC AMP
2
IN
OUT
ECHO
9
IC503
RV502
MIC VR
RV501
ECHO VR
J501
MIC
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-13
3-14
3-7.
INTERFACE CONTROL BLOCK DIAGRAM
17
16
15
27
14
23
3
24
7
2
11
33
47
64
77
65
58
41
5
17
IF-92 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-33)
1
4
3
8
6
5
SYSTEM CONTROL
(SEE PAGE 3-8)
VIDEO
(SEE PAGE 3-9)
IC404
IF CON
IC405
RESET
CN404
SC0
SI0
SO0
XIFBUSY
XIFCS
XFRRST
/SC
SO
SI
BUSY
/CS
/FRRST
05
A MUTE
VMUTE
/AMUTE
/VMUTE
IR
OUT
DISPLAY
RETURN
TOP MENU
TVS
PUSH
ENTER
MENU
S405
S408
S404
S402
S401
S403
S406
S412
CURSOR
SEG 1 – 18
DIG 1 – 13
X401
8MHz
ND401
FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR TUBE
CN406
1
IC406
REMOTE COMMANDER
RECEIVER
SC0
SI0
SO0
XIFBUSY
XIFCS
XFRRST
34
O/C
35
PLAY
S409
S407
37
POWER
S411
36
DISPLAY
XIN
XOUT
1
VOUT
8
/RST
CURSOR STICK
3
2
1
CN402
AUDIO
(SEE PAGE 3-12)
PREQ
S410
125nsec
IC404 3
3.8Vp-p
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-15
3-16
3-8.
POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM (1/3)
12
6
•
7
SWITCHING REGULATOR
(HS11S1U) (K380: TW)
(SEE PAGE 4-45)
CN201
EVER–13V
P311
T101
POWER
TRANSFORMER
D211
D311
D611
D511
D313
D101
AC IN
F101
CN101
16
IF-92 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-33)
POWER 2
(SEE PAGE 3-17)
POWER 2
(SEE PAGE 3-17)
SW–13V
SW–13V
D621/D622
STANDBY/ON
Q621
LED DRIVE
PC101
PHOTO COUPLER
IC101
SWITCH
8
11
3
2
1
13
1
2
Q211
Q311
Q611
Q404, 405
PS401
L101,102
LINE
FILTER
D221
P611
P511
+3.3V REG
Q712
POWER
CONTROL
L211
L221
L311
L611
L511
26
37
IC404
IF CON
IC406
REMOTE
COMMANDER
RECEIVER
IC405
RESET
IC411
IC301
SHUNT REG
PCONT
IC403
+1.8V REG
POWER
30 PONCHK
VKK
F2
F1
EVER+3.3V
EVER+3.3V
EVER+3.3V
AI+5V
+3.3V
+5V
+1.8V
SW+11V
+11V
3.3V MNT
ND401
FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR TUBE
DC/DC
CONVERTER
AU+11V
PS402
3
VIN
2
VOUT
CN401
2
CN403
CN404
13
3
11
12
8
4
1
5
7
5
CN402
7
3
6
2
1
6
•
7
SW+11V
EVER+11V
SW+5V
SW+3.3V
EVER+3.3V
EVER–13V
P-CONT
POWER
SW201
POWER
Q401,402,
T401
CN406
2
E +3.3V
PUSH
ENTER
CURSOR STICK
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-17
3-18
3-9.
POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM (2/3)
12
6
•
7
ETXNY381N2F (K380: HK, SP)
(SEE PAGE 4-43)
CN201
SW+11V
EVER+11V
EV–13V
SW+5V
D201
T101
D202
D203
F203
D104–D1107
AC IN
F101
CN101
16
PD202
PD201
(ON)
(STANDBY)
PC101
PHOTO COUPLER
IC101
SWITCH
8
SW+3.3V
11
EV+3.3V
3
EV–13V
2
P-CONT
1
POWER
13
1
2
Q301
Q203
Q204
L101, 102
LINE
FILTER
Q202
+3.3V REG
Q205
POWER
CONTROL
L301
D301
L205
L201
L202
L206
F202
F201
L203
D204
L204
IC201
SHUNT REG
IC202
SHUNT REG
POWER
SW201
EV+3.3V
SW+5V
SW+3.3V
SW+11V
P-CONT
POWER
EVER+11V
TO IF-92 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 3-16)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
3-19
3-20E
3-10. POWER BLOCK DIAGRAM (3/3)
1
11
19
AV-63 BOARD
(SEE PAGE 4-27 to 4-30)
OPTICAL
DEVICE
16
MB-103 BOARD (SEE PAGE 4-11 to 4-24)
CN101
CN102
CN203
INLIMIT
SENSOR
5
CN204
IC102
VIDEO
BUFFER
IC101
–5V REG
3
OUT
IC601
AUDIO
D/A CONVERTER
IC101
EEPROM
IC202
FOCUS/TRACKING
COIL DRIVE,
SPINDLE/SLED/
LOADING
MOTOR DRIVE
IC404
16M SDRAM
AI+5V
2
IN
IC203
+5V REG
1
OUT
3
IN
IC402
+3.3V REG
4
VOUT
5
VIN
IC401
+1.8V REG
4
VOUT
5
VIN
IC302
+3.3V REG
4
VOUT
5
VIN
MUTE V
SW–13V
EVER+3.3V
AU+11V
D201
IC204
OPTICAL DIGITAL
OUT
CN203
25
CN601
POWER (1/3)
(SEE PAGE 3-16)
POWER (1/3)
(SEE PAGE 3-16)
IC201
AUDIO AMP
Q201
Q203, 216
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
OUT
FILTER
FL110
7
4
IC104
SYSTEM
CONTROL
FILTER
FL103
FILTER
FL201
+3.3V
FILTER
FL105
2
+5V
FILTER
FL104
1
+1.8V
FILTER
FL109
5
CN202
6
5
7
3
+11V
3.3V MNT
IC303
16M DRAM
IC201
DVD/CD RF AMP,
DIGITAL
SERVO
IC403
AV DECODER
IC301
ARP,
SERVO DSP
VCC
MOD
LED
FILTER
FL404
FILTER
FL403
FILTER
FL402
AU+5V
IC103
PLL
FILTER
FL101
IC106
FLASH
MEMORY
IC107
OTP
FILTER
FL106
or
FILTER
FL102
IC202
AUDIO AMP
2
3
CN204
IC405
16M SDRAM
IC504
+5V REG
2
3
IC503
ECHO
IC501
MIC AMP
IC502
MIC AMP
1
3
OUT
IN
MC-139 BOARD
CN501
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-1
4-2
SECTION 4
PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
4-1.
FRAME SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
FRAME SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
2P
CN101
1
AC_IN(L)
2
AC_IN(N)
7P
CN202
7
S W_-1 3
6
A I+5V
5
A U+11v
4
GND
3
EVER+3.3V
2
A_MUTE
1
V MUTE
13P
CN401
1
P OWER
2
P -CONT
3
EVER-13V
4
M_GND
5
M_GND
6
S W+11V
7
S W+11v
8
S W+3.3V
9
D_GND
10
D_GND
11
EVER+3.3V
12
+5V
13
+11V(AUDIO)
6P
CN403
1
+1.8V
2
+5V
3
GND
4
SW+3.3V
5
+11V
6
M_GND
9P
CN404
1
SOO
2
GND
3
SCO
4
SIO
5
XIFBUSY
6
XIFCS
7
3.3V_MNT
8
XFRRST
9
GND
7P
CN402
7
SW-13V
6
AI+5V
5
AU+11V
4
GND
3
EVER+3.3V
2
A_MUTE
1
V_MUTE
13P
CN201
1
POWER
2
P-CONT
3
EVER-13V
4
M_GND
5
M_GND
6
SW+11V
7
SW+11v
8
SW+3.3V
9
D_GND
10
D_GND
11
EVER+3.3V
12
+5V
13
+11V(AUDIO)
9P
CN101
1
S OO
2
GND
3
SCO
4
S IO
5
X IFBUSY
6
X IFCS
7
3 .3V_MNT
8
XFRRST
9
GND
6P
CN102
1
+1.8V
2
+5V
3
GND
4
S W+3.3V
5
+11V
6 M _GND
26P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
CN203
26P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
5P
CN201
1
2
3
4
5
9P
CN204
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
9P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
5P
CN001
1
2
3
4
5
5P
CN406
1
GND
2
EVER+3.3V
3
CURSOR
4
N.C.
5
N.C.
CN203
25P
CN601
25P
5P
CN501
1
GND
2
-11V
3
+11V
4
MI C
5
MIC+ECH0
5P
CN204
1
2
3
4
5
6P
CN103
1
2
3
4
5
6
10P
CN405
1
3.3v_MNT
2
XFRRST
3
XIFBUSY
4
XIFCS
5
SIO
6
SOO
7
SCO
8
GND
9
IFRST
10
PCONT
Y
C
G
G
S
S
J103
J104
J101
J201
IC204
D IN
1
VCC
2
GND
3
J501
S401-412
MS-81
BOARD
MB-103 BOARD
IF-92 BOARD
AV-63 BOARD
F
N.C.
D
FCS-
H
VR
RF
DVD LD
C
FCS+
PD
CD LD
LD GND
GND
VC
LDM -
N.C.
GND
LDM +
GND
OCSW1
TRK-
FCS-
CKSW1
A
TRK+
SW/N.C.
VCC
CD LD
E
TRK+
SW
B
MOD
G
GND
LD GND
VC
B
GND
A
C
D
CKSW1
GND
LDM -
LDM +
OCSW1
VCC
PD
N.C.
INLI M
N.C.
GND
DVD LD
SLA+
H
SLA-
SPM-
SLB-
MOD
FMM-35
LED
RF
SPM+
SLA-
E
SPM+
G
SLB+
FMO-002
F
SPM-
FCS+
SLA+
VR
TRK-
GND
SLB+
LED
INLI M
FM0-001
SLB-
B to B
PF-129
HARNESS
HARNESS
AF-122
B TO B
ART+
2
6
7
RGBSEL
18
WIDE
19
17
IPSW
Y/G
CR/B
AU+5V
DSEL
SPDIF
4
8
16
RMUTE
22
25
D_GND
D_GND
ALT-
P_GND_SPDIF
CB/R
24
P_GND_AUDIO
5
12
9
Y
14
20
1
D_GND
C
21
ALT+
MAMUTE
V
3
10
11
LMUTE
23
13
15
D_GND
ART-
5
2
8
RGBSEL
25
17
P_GND_SPDIF
1
CR/B
ALT+
10
13
ART+
4
P_GND_AUDIO
7
22
19
ALT-
20
21
3
23
ART-
SPDIF
9
24
6
RMUTE
WIDE
D_GND
Y/G
14
C
V
LMUTE
D_GND
DSEL
CB/R
12
16
18
D_GND
IPSW
Y
D_GND
MAMUT E
11
15
AU+5V
-11V
MIC+ECHO
MI C
+11V
GND
MC-139 BOARD
HARNESS
AM-130
RF MON
RXD
+3.3V
GND
GND
TXD
OPTICAL PICK-UP
UNIT
FOCUS/
TRACKING
COIL
FLA T CABLE
DVD/CD
PD IC
FLAT CABLE
M
SPINDLE
MOTOR
SLED
MOTOR
M
FLAT CABLE
FOR
CHECK
MF-129
FPC
CURSOR
PUSH
ENTER
ND401
FLUORESCENT
INDICATOR TUBE
FOR CHECK
HARNESS
SWITCHING
REGURATOR
AC IN
COAXIAL
R
L
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
R
OPTICAL
C
R
LINE OUT
VIDEO1
AUDIO2
VIDEO2
OUT
S VIDEO
C
Y
AUDIO1
AUDIO1
AUDIO2
B
L
MI C
(STOP), (PLA Y), (P AUSE),
(PREV), (NEXT), (O/C),
(RETURN), DISPLA Y, DVD MENU,
TITLE, PVEQ, TVS
16
M
M001
LOADING MOTOR
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-4
4-3
60.6nsec
29.5nsec
37.4nsec
MB-103 BOARD
2 IC103 qd,qg
1 IC104 tf
3.3Vp-p
3.3Vp-p
3 IC103 3,8
3.3Vp-p
4 IC103 9,q;
40.8nsec
3.3Vp-p
5 IC102 ed PAL
H
H
5 IC102 ed NTSC
H
H
H
H
H
AV-63 BOARD
1 IC102 w; PAL
1 IC102 w; NTSC
1.4Vp-p
1.0Vp-p
1.9Vp-p
1.4Vp-p
2 IC102 ws NTSC
1.0Vp-p
2 IC102 ws PAL
H
1.4Vp-p
3 IC102 wf,wl NTSC
H
1.9Vp-p
4 IC102 ea NTSC
3 IC102 wf,wl PAL
H
1.9Vp-p
4 IC102 ea PAL
1.9Vp-p
2.5Vp-p
NTSC:75% COLOR BAR PLAY BACK
PAL :100% COLOR BAR PLAY BACK
125nsec
IF-92 BOARD
1 IC404 3
3.8Vp-p
8.6µsec
4.4µsec
2 ND401 1,ys
14.4Vp-p
3 T401 3
21.7Vp-p
For printed wiring boards:
•
: indicates a lead wire mounted on the component
side.
•
: indicates a lead wire mounted on the printed side.
•
a
: Through hole.
•
: Pattern from the side which enables seeing.
(The other layers’ patterns are not indicated.)
For schematic diagrams:
• All capacitors are in µF unless otherwise noted. pF
: µµF. 50V or less are not indicated except for
electrolytics and tantalums.
• All resistors are in ohms, 1/4W (Chip resistors : 1/
10W) un-less otherwise specified.
kΩ = 1000Ω, MΩ = 1000kΩ.
• Caution when replacing chip parts.
New parts must be attached after removal of chip.
Be careful not to heat the minus side of tantalum
capacitor, because it is damaged by the heat.
• All variable and adjustable resistors have
characteristic curve B, unless otherwise noted.
•
: non flammable resistor.
•
: fusible resistor.
•
: panel designation.
•
f
: internal component.
•
: adjustment for repair.
•
: B+ Line.
•
: B– Line.
• Circled numbers refer to waveforms.
• Voltages are dc between measurement point.
• Readings are taken with a color-bar signal on DVD
reference disc and when playing CD reference
disc.
• Readings are taken with a digital multimeter (DC
10MΩ).
• Voltage variations may be noted due to normal
production tolerances.
Caution:
Pattern face side:
Parts on the pattern face side seen from
(Side A)
the pattern face are indicated.
Parts face side:
Parts on the parts face side seen from
(Side B)
the parts face are indicated.
When indicating parts by reference
number, please include the board
name.
Note:
The components identi-
fied by mark
or dotted
line with mark
are criti-
cal for safety.
Replace only with part
number specified.
Note:
Les composants identifiés par
une marque
sont critiques
pour la sécurité.
Ne les remplacer que par une
pièce portant le numéro
spécifié.
4-2.
PRINTED WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
THIS NOTE IS COMMON FOR WIRING BOARDS AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS.
(In addition to this, the necessary note is printed in each block)
•
Abbreviation
HK
; Hong Kong model
TW
; Taiwan model
SP
; Singapore model
; Malaysia model
; Thailand model
; Philippine model
; Vietnam model
B+
B–
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-5
4-6
LOADING
MS-81
MS-81 (LOADING) PRINTED WIRING BOARD AND SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM
For printed wiring board
There are a few cases that the part printed
on this diagram isn’t mounted in this model.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
A
B
C
D
M001
5P
CN001
1
2
3
4
5
S001
1
2
3
4
5
JL001
JL002
JL003
JL004
JL005
LDM+
LDM-
OCSW1
CKSW1
GND
MB-103 BOARD (2/7)
CN201
(SEE PAGE 4-13)
LOADING
MOTOR
DETECT
CHUCK/TRAY
16
MS-81 BOARD
LODING
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
16
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-8
DVD/CD RF AMP, DIGITAL SERVO, MOTOR DRIVE, SERVO, AV DECODER, SDRAM, SYSTEM CONTROL, AUDIO DAC, PLL
MB-103
MB-103 (DVD/CD RF AMP, DIGITAL SERVO, MOTOR DRIVE, SERVO, AV DECODER, SDRAM,
SYSTEM CONTROL, AUDIO DAC, PLL) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
MB-103 BOARD (SIDE A)
For printed wiring board
There are a few cases that the part printed
on this diagram isn’t mounted in this model.
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
1
41
CN101
A-5
CN102
B-1
CN103
A-8
CN201
A-3
CN202
E-2
CN203
F-1
CN204
D-1
CN301
B-6
CN601
H-6
IC102
E-6
IC104
C-9
IC301
B-5
IC302
D-4
IC402
H-9
IC403
F-8
IC501
E-3
IC502
F-4
IC601
G-6
RV401
H-8
RV501
F-6
RV502
G-5
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-9
DVD/CD RF AMP, DIGITAL SERVO, MOTOR DRIVE, SERVO, AV DECODER, SDRAM, SYSTEM CONTROL, AUDIO DAC, PLL
MB-103
MB-103 BOARD (SIDE B)
2
3
4
41
D201
F-1
D202
G-1
IC101
A-8
IC103
D-6
IC106
C-9
IC107
C-9
IC108
C-7
IC201
E-3
IC202
C-2
IC303
C-5
IC401
D-7
IC404
F-7
IC405
F-9
IC406
F-8
IC503
G-3
IC504
F-5
IC505
H-4
Q201
F-2
Q202
G-2
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-11
4-12
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board.
DVD/CD RF AMP, DIGITAL SERVO
MB-103 (1/7)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
XLDON
47uH
L201
0.1u
B
C262
2200p
B
C212
TE
6.3V
47u
C242
4700
R206
XX
R209
SSDFCTI
0.01u
B
C243
33
R249
CN203
26P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
XX
C267
100
R211
XX
R247
SSWD
SSRD
330p
C261
2200p
B
C211
0.01u
B
C260
0.1u
B
C241
SSCK
SIGO
100
R235
4700p
B
C233
47k
R251
0.1u
B
C244
100
R246
SSCS
0.001u
C253
+3.3V
0.01u
B
C248
RFMON
33
R248
CN202
XX
1
2
3
4
5
0.1u
B
C265
2SB1132-T100-QR
Q202
MIRR
XX
R268
CN204
9P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
2.2M
R263
2200p
B
C213
GND
0.01u
B
C201
100
R256
0.047u
B
C256
16V
10u
C238
100
R212
0.01u
B
C235
0.01u
B
C266
560p
C236
0.1u
B
C251
TZC
XX
C239
XX
R267
0.01u
B
C202
0.047u
B
C257
4700p
B
C232
100k
R264
27k
R265
47k
R245
2200p
B
C210
0.01u
B
C247
2SB1132-T100-QR
Q201
0.1u
B
C252
16V
10u
C221
XX
C269
SS_MON
0.01u
B
C245
1k
R244
0.1u
B
C255
XX
D201
0.01u
B
C254
FE
330
R210
6.3V
47u
C234
+5V
12k
R260
33
R234
47uH
L202
XX
D202
33
R236
16V
10u
C263
PI
0.01u
B
C264
FL201
XX
C237
SP3728ACB
IC201
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
JL201
JL202
JL203
JL205
JL204
JL206
JL207
JL208
JL209
JL210
JL211
JL213
JL212
0
R273
XX
R266
XX
R272
XX
C224
CN203
26P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
CN204
9P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
INLIM
TRK-
FCS+
FCS-
SVC
TRK+
SVC
SPM+
SLA-
SLB+
SPM-
SLB-
SLA+
SSCS
B
SSDFCTI
H
SSWD
F
TE
SSDFCTI
D
DVD_LD
FE
G
SLA-
H
FCS+
SLB+
TRK+
A
B
FCS-
CD_LD
D
DVD_LD
SSCS
G
PI
SSCK
MIRR
SPM+
C
C
SPM-
TRK-
E
SLA+
FE
CD_LD
PI
SLB-
TE
FE
SSCK
SSWD
SSRD
TZC
E
F
SSRD
A
MIRR
TZC
TE
PI
INLIM
SLA+
SLB-
SLB+
SPM+
SLA-
SPM-
FCS+
FCS-
TRK+
TRK-
INLIM
CDPD
N.C
DVDPD
RFIN
MEVO
CDLD
MIRR
VPA
DVD LD
RF
TZIN
F
GND
E
MB
SLA-
MEV
AIP
RFIP
DIP
FE
D
LDON
TPA
ATON
BYP2
VCC
LD GND
F
INLIM
A
SLB-
C2
FE
MIN
G
MON
RF
AIN
SLB+
LDSELO
TE
D
SRD
C
SCLK
GND
PI
RX
PII
BYP
A
GND
N.C
FCS+
GND
E
H
D2
WIN
SWD
C
TZC
B2
VC
B
MLPF
FNP
H
TRK-
VNA
FCS-
VR
TRK+
CN
SW/N.C
WPP
SLA+
CD LD
B
LED
VPB
CP
VNB
DFT
TPH
SDEN
PI
DVDLD
VCI
SIGO
MP
V33
ATOP
DIN
FNN
VC
G
TE
MOD
SPM+
PD
A2
SPM-
SW/N.C.
VR
C
D
VCC
FCS+
A
TRK-
F
RF
MOD
N.C.
N.C.
VC
LD GND
DVD LD
CD LD
TRK+
FCS-
H
GND
PD
GND
B
G
E
SLA-
GND
SLA+
INLIM
SLB-
SPM+
SPM-
SLB+
LED
DVD/CD
PD IC
DVD/CD
LD MODULE
FOCUS
COIL
TRACKING
COIL
OPTICAL DEVICE
BASE UNIT
KHM-270AAA/Z-NP
M
M
INLIMIT
SENSOR
FMO-002
FLAT CABLE
FMM-001
FLAT CABLE
DVD LD DRIVE
CD LD DRIVE
IC201
DVD/CD RF AMP
SERVO ERROR PROCESS
5
TO(2/7)
4
TO(2/7)
1
TO(7/7)
2
TO(7/7)
TO(3/7)
3
6
TO(6/7)
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
16
3.3
3.3
0.5
3.3
0
3.3
2.5
0.5
2.5
2.6
0
2.6
2.5
0
2.5
2.6
0
2.5
2.5
4.8
0.2
0.2
4.8
0.1
3.8
0
2.1
2.5
3.3
2.4
2.7
0
3.4
3.4
0
3.4
1.7
1.7
3.3
2.5
0.1
1.7
2.0
1.9
0
0.1
2.6
3.6
3.6
4.0
4.0
2.4
3.3
4.8
2.8
2.1
3.3
2.1
3.4
3.3
3.2
0.6
4.7
4.7
0.8
2.2
3.7
4.4
SLED MOTOR
SPINDLE MOTOR
TRACKING SERVO DVD/CD CDV
SPINDLE SERVO (SPEED AND PHASE)
FOCUS SERVO
SLED SERVO DVD/CD
PB
AUDIO
SIGNAL PATH
Y
SIGNAL
CHROMA
VIDEO SIGNAL
Y/CHROMA
SIGNAL PATH
MB-103 BOARD (1/7)
DVD/CD RF AMP DIGITAL SERVO
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK:PB MODE
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-13
4-14
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board of MB-103 board.
• Refer to page 4-5 for printed wiring board of MS-81 board.
MOTOR DRIVE
MB-103 (2/7)
LOADING
MS-81
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
MB-103 BOARD (2/7)
MOTOR DRIVE
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK:PB MODE
GND
TRMP
MDSO
XX
C208
10k
R229
0.1u
B
C272
R202
XX
10k
R259
JL248
XX
R203
CKSW1
XX
R228
120k
R218
FDRV+
10k
R214
0.1u
B
C220
150k
R220
C215
100p
0.5%
100k
R254
0.01u
B
C249
10k
R269
TSENSU
+11V
150k
R221
0.001u
B
C259
120k
R227
SPMUTE
0.1u
B
C219
33k
R252
XX
R215
M_GND
0.5%
56k
R255
0.01u
B
C258
0.01u
B
C250
TDRV+
10k
R225
1k
R216
470k
R233
680k
R231
FAN8034L
IC202
1
2
3
4
5
6
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
50
51
52
49
13
25
26
37
38
39
11
12
9
10
7
8
33k
R230
10k
R261
0.5%
100k
R250
0.001u B
C204
C216
220p
XDRVMUTE
XX
R208
33k
R240
+3.3V
33k
R232
+5V
10k
R213
XX
R204
TDRV-
TRMM
SPFG
470k
R243
56k
R222
XX
C268
R201
XX
JL247
FDRV-
XX
C227
SLE
XX
C217
0.001u
B
C229
XX
C207
0.001u
B
C228
LMM
0.01u
B
C270
1k
R217
TSD
0.033u
B
C246
SLDA
XX
C205
C206
XX
XX
R205
470k
R226
LMP
1500p
C218
270k
R224
33k
R239
33k
R238
SVC
OCSW1
0.015u
C214
16V
47u
C271
XX
R237
220p
C226
LMCTL
120k
R219
DSENS
0.5%
56k
R253
0.033u
B
C240
33k
R241
4700p
B
C230
OCSW2
XX
C209
0.001u B
C203
56k
R223
220k
R242
SLDB
100p
C225
MDPO
100
R207
330
R262
0.1u
B
C273
XX
R280
TSENSD
CL201
CL202
CL203
CL204
CL205
XX
R271
XX
R274
XX
R270
XX
C276
TSENSO
XX
C223
XX
R257
XX
C274
XX
R276
XX
R275
XX
R258
XX
C231
XX
C222
5P
CN001
1
2
3
4
5
CN201
5P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
FCS+
FCS-
TRK+
TRK-
SLA-
SLB+
SLA+
SPM+
SPM-
SLB-
CKSW1
SPM-
LDM+
LDM+
FCS+
TRK+
FCS-
OCSW1
SPM+
SLA-
SLB+
TRK-
CKSW1
LDM-
OCSW1
LDM-
SLB-
SLA+
TRK+
TRK-
FCS+
SPM-
SLA+
SLB+
SPM+
SLA-
SLB-
FCS-
OPIN2-
FWD
OUT5
PGND1
IN5+
IN4-
DO5-
SW
IN3+
DO4+
MUTE12
IN2-
OUT4
MUTE34
D
IN2+
REV
DO1-
CTL
DO3-
IN5-
OUT2
DO5+
DO2-
IN1+
TMP
DO2+
DO6+
OPIN1+
MUTE34
DO3+
DSENS
TSENS
TMM
OCSW1
PVCC2
GND
TSD-M
GND
OCSW2
VREF
LDM+
DO6-
LDM-
MUTE5
OUT3
CKSW1
POWER SAVE
OPIN1-
OUT1
D
IN4+
-
PGND2
MSC
MUTE12
MUTE5
OPOUT1
SVCC
OPIN2+
PVCC1
SGND
IN3-
OPOUT2
+
DO1+
DO4-
PS
IN1-
TSD-M
OCSW1
CKSW1
LDM+
LDM-
GND
CHUCK/TRAY
DETECT
M001
LOADING MOTOR
MS-81 BOARD
NOT USE
7
TO(7/7)
TO(6/7)
8
9
TO(3/7)
TO(7/7)
10
4
TO(1/7)
5
TO(1/7)
TO(3/7)
11
12 TO(6/7)
16
IC202
MOTOR DRIVE
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.3
0
3.3
3.3
3.3
3.3
3.3
3.3
5.5
11.3
1.7
3.5
3.5
3.2
1.7
4.7
1.7
1.7
11.2
3.3
5.5
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
6.8
4.2
5.5
S001
M
SPINDLE SERVO (SPEED AND PHASE)
SIGNAL PATH
SLED SERVO DVD/CD
TRACKING SERVO DVD/CD CDV
FOCUS SERVO
FMM-35
FLAT
CABLE
(SEE PAGE 4-5)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-15
4-16
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board.
SERVO
MB-103 (3/7)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
MB-103 BOARD (3/7)
SERVO
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK: PB MODE
XSRQ
XSDPCS
XWAIT
XARPCS
XSDPIT
XARPIT
CDDOUT
HA7
HA2
HA6
CDLRCK/TDOKT
HA5
HA3
XSAK
HA4
HA0
HA1
HD14
+5V
SVC
HD15
SPFG
HD10
+3.3V
TCK
SLE
HD12
GND
TDIKT
PI
HD13
TMS
FE
HD8
SIGO
XFRRST
XSHD
HD11
SDCK
HD9
SDEF
TE
2200
R323
XX
R305
470
R313
4700p
B
C305
0.01u
B
C304
0.01u
B
C321
0.5%
22k
R321
10k
R326
4700p
B
C318
XX
R304
0.068u
B
C312
0.5%
10k
R327
470
R315
100p
C310
XX
R341
4700
R335
100
R311
10k
R324
0.1u
B
C324
XX
R342
0.01u
B
C314
0.01u
B
C328
XX
R345
4700
R316
0.01u
B
C315
0.5%
1800
R334
XX
R309
0.01u
B
C325
4700p
B
C330
27k
R328
0.01u
B
C329
0.5%
10k
R319
JL317
2200
R329
CN301
XX
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
XX
R343
2200
R330
470
R314
0.01u
B
C322
JL310
6800
R325
JL309
150k
R333
0.01u
B
C319
0.5%
220
R312
0.01u
B
C326
0
R302
JL318
C302
XX
0
R301
0.5%
1k
R322
XX
R344
2200
R332
2200
R331
4700p
B
C320
0.01u
B
C311
0.01u
B
C323
XX
R308
0.01u B
C327
0.1u
B
C317
0.033u
B
C313
100u
C308
6.3V
CXD9703R
IC301
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144 145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156 157 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 173 174 175 176
0.5%
33k
R320
470
R318
4700p
B
C316
JL335
JL337
JL333
JL336
JL334
JL319
JL325
JL326
CDDATA/EMU1
CDBCK/EMU0
CDLRCK/TDOKT
XX
R338
XX
R339
XX
R340
SSCS
LMM
SSCK
LMP
SSWD
SSRD
JL322
JL321
JL324
JL323
JL320
JL327
TSD
INLIM
SPMUTE
JL314
JL316
JL315
SLDB
SLDA
JL312
JL311
LMCTL
JL313
33MARP
SSDFCTI
MIRR
TZC
SDI0
SDI1
SDI2
SDI3
SDI4
SDI5
SDI6
SDI7
10k
R336
0.1u
B
C331
10k
R346
10k
R347
10k
R348
10k
R349
FDRV-
FDRV+
TDRV+
TDRV-
JL338
JL339
JL341
JL340
+1.8V
0
R352
0
R351
0.01u
B
C332
0.01u
B
C333
XX
R337
100
R360
B
C335
0.01u
JL328
JL332
JL331
JL330
JL329
JL342
JL343
JL308
JL301
JL303
JL306
JL304
JL305
JL302
JL307
0.01u
B
C334
10k
R358
10k
R359
10k
R317
0.01u
B
C338
0.01u
B
C340
XX
C342
0.01u
B
C343
B
C344
0.01u
XX
C345
0.01u
B
C339
XX
C341
0.01u
B
C337
XX
C336
XX
R363
CL301
CL302
CL308
CL309
CL313
CL314
CL315
B
C309
0.01u
IC303
GM71V18160
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35
41 42 43 44 45 46
11
15
36
40
24
25
47 48 49 50
FL301
XX
XX
FL302
IC302
MM1385ENLE
1
2
3
4
5
1k
R303
XRST
SS_MON
JL344
XRD
XWRH
MDSO
MDPO
TCK
TCK
TDIKT
TMS
TMS
XFRRST
TDIKT
RAMD15
RAMD13
RAMD14
RAMD10
RAMD9
SDI2
RAMD11
RAMD12
RAMD8
CDLRCK/TDOKT
SDI7
SDI6
SDI5
SDI3
SDI4
SDI1
RAMD6
RAMD5
RAMD4
RAMD3
RAMD2
RAMD1
RAMD7
RAMD0
RAMA9
RAMA8
RAMA7
RAMA6
RAMA5
RAMA4
RAMA3
RAMA2
RAMA1
RAMA0
MDPO
SDEF
XSAK
XSHD
SDCK
CDDOUT
SSCS
LMM
LMP
SSCK
SSWD
SSRD
CDBCK/EMU0
CDDATA/EMU1
SDEF
XSAK
XSRQ
XSHD
SDCK
CDDOUT
SDI0
SDI1
SDI2
SDI3
SDI4
SDI5
SDI6
SDI7
MDSO
TESTK3
TESTK2
TESTK1
TESTK0
TESTK3
TESTK2
TESTK1
TESTK0
XSDPIT
XSDPCS
XSDPCS
FDRV-
FDRV+
TDRV-
TDRV+
MDPO
MDSO
FDRV-
FDRV+
TDRV-
TDRV+
XSDPIT
SLE
SPFG
RAMD0
RAMD1
RAMD2
RAMD3
RAMD4
RAMD5
RAMD6
RAMD7
RAMD8
RAMD9
RAMD10
RAMD11
RAMD12
RAMD13
RAMD14
RAMD15
RAMA0
RAMA1
RAMA2
RAMA3
RAMA4
RAMA5
RAMA6
RAMA7
RAMA8
RAMA9
XFRRST
XFRRST
TMS
TCK
TDIKT
CDLRCK/TDOKT
CDDATA/EMU1
CDBCK/EMU0
CDLRCK/TDOKT
INLIM
LMCTL
SLDB
SLDA
SLE
SPFG
SLDA
SLDB
LMM
LMP
LMCTL
SSDFCTI
MIRR
TZC
SSDFCTI
MIRR
TZC
INLIM
SSRD
SSWD
SSCK
SSCS
XSRQ
SDI0
TCK
TRST
EMU0
TO JIG
EMU1
3.3V
GND
GND
TDO
TMS
TDI
TDI
VDDA2 3.3V
MD4
GIO5/PGIN
VDDD0 3.3V
XRD
DATA/EMU1
MA2
VSSA5
GIO11/TMC2
A2
LRCK/TDO
VSS
MD9
VSSD1
D6
XMWR
MD14
VDDA3 3.3V
PWM1
MIRR
VSS
TZC
A6
VRBA
TESTK0
SD5
VDD3.3V
ADC4
PDM3
MA1
VDDA5 3.3V
SD1
ADC0
A0
VDD3.3V
FR2
GIO7/SDO
XSHD
DOUT
MD3
VSSA1
JITPWM
IREF
TMS
GIO4/PGREF
BIAS
VSS
MDP0
MA7
TCK
VSS
VDD1.8V
MD8
D5
MD15
GIO2/INT4
TESTK1
GIO10/FGIN
RFIN2
PWM0
PDM1
MD5
DFCTI
VDDD1 3.3V
VSS
A5
VSS
ADC5
XWAT
D3
VSSA4
HCS
MA4
VSSA0
SD2
ADC3
GIO3/INT5
R1
XSAK
FR3
VDD3.3V
XSRQ
SDCK
MD2
INM
RFD
AOUT
TRST
MDS0
VREF
MD13
MA6
D7
VDD1.8V
GIO13
VSS
VRT
MD6
VSSA3
XCS
VDD3.3V
GIO1/INT3
PWM2
TESTK3
VSSD2
MA3
GIO9/GREF
VDD3.3V
CLKIN
A4
ADC6
D1
HINT
MD1
MD11
VCO
SD0
ADC2
R2
SDEF
VDD1.8V
XRAS
Y
VDDA4 3.3V
VSS
INP
PLCKO
A3
VSSA2
MA8
SD6
D2
GIO6/SDI
LOCK
VSSD0
XWR
BCLK/EMU0
GIO12
MD7
XINT
RFIN1
PDM2
MA5
TESTK2
VRB
ADC7
D4
A7
VDD1.8V
VSS
MD0
MD10
VDD1.8V
D0
XCAS
GIO0/INT2
MD12
VDD1.8V
VDDD2 3.3V
PDM0
GIO8/SCK
SD4
ADC1
MA9
MA0
SD3
VRTA
XRESET
FR1
VSS
A1
VSS
VDDA0 3.3V
SD7
VDDA1 3.3V
I/O13
I/O15
I/O10
A3
N.C.
I/O3
I/O14
RAS
I/O11
I/O4
A4
I/O5
N.C.
WE
GND
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
I/O6
GND
I/O8
A7
A0
A9
A1
I/O12
A6
LCAS
I/O0
I/O2
UCAS
GND
N.C.
I/O1
I/O9
VDD
N.C.
I/O7
A8
VDD
A5
OE
A2
VDD
(2012)
(2012)
CONT
GND
NOISE
VIN
VOUT
TO(7/7)
13
TO(4/7)
16
TO(1/7)
3
TO(7/7)
14
TO(6/7)
17
TO(4/7,6/7,7/7)
15
TO(2/7)
9
18 TO(4/7,6/7)
19 TO(4/7)
20 TO(4/7)
TO(2/7)
11
16
SERVO
IC301
16M D RAM
IC303
IC302
3.3V REG
21 TO(6/7)
1.7
0.7
3.3
2.4
1.7
1.7
1.7
1.6
3.3
1.0
1.7
1.7
2.5
3.3
1.0
0.5
3.4
2.6
1.6
3.3
1.7
0.7
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
1.7
1.9
1.7
1.7
1.7
2.3
0
1.7
0.7
1.5
1.8
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.7
1.0
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.3
0.3
2.4
0.2
3.4
0.2
3.4
3.4
3.4
2.6
1.7
1.7
2.9
1.7
3.0
2.8
3.0
2.8
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.4
2.7
2.7
2.9
2.8
2.9
2.7
2.7
2.9
1.7
3.0
2.7
3.3
3.0
1.7
2.3
3.4
2.3
3.3
3.3
3.4
1.7
1.6
1.7
3.4
0
3.4
0
0
0
1.7
1.9
1.5
1.6
1.6
1.6
1.2
2.5
0
3.4
2.6
2.6
2.7
2.2
2.5
2.2
2.4
2.8
3.4
1.6
1.7
0
1.7
3.3
2.2
1.7
0.6
1.7
0
3.4
2.0
0
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
0
1.7
1.7
1.7
0
0
0
4.8
4.8
3.3
1.3
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
Y/CHROMA
AUDIO
SIGNAL PATH
SLED SERVO DVD/CD
SPINDLE SERVO (SPEED AND PHASE)
SIGNAL
FOCUS SERVO
Y
TRACKING SERVO DVD/CD CDV
CHROMA
VIDEO SIGNAL
PB
SIGNAL PATH
B+
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-17
4-18
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board.
AV DECODER
MB-103 (4/7)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
DREQ1
TDIKT
SDI2
CDLRCK/TDOKT
DREQ0
SDI1
HD7
XWAIT
SDI0
HD8
HD6
XAVDIT
HD5
HA4
XWRH
SDCK
HD4
HA5
HA20
SDEF
HD3
HA7
HA19
XSHD
HD2
HA6
HA21
XSAK
HD1
HA3
HA18
XSRQ
HA2
HA16
27MAVD
HA0
HA17
XRST
HA1
HA15
+1.8V
512FSAVD
HA14
SPDIF1
HA13
+3.3V
BCK
XRD
XAVDCS2
HA12
LRCK
XAVDCS3
HA11
HD12
HA8
HD11
HA9
ACH12
HD10
CDDOUT
HD9
CDDATA/EMU1
HD0
CDBCK/EMU0
HD15
HD14
HD13
SDI7
SDI6
HA10
SDI5
TMS
DACK0
SDI4
DACK1
CDLRCK/TDOKT
SDI3
TCK
GND
JL401
JL402
10
R430
XX
C414
10k
R412
10k
R426
0.01u
B
C416
0.01u
B
C422
0.01u
B
C423
0.01u
B
C426
XX
C430
0.01u
B
C431
0.01u
B
C432
XX
C433
XX
C434
0.01u
B
C435
0.01u
B
C436
0.01u
B
C429
0.01u
B
C425
XX
C424
XX
C421
0.01u
B
C418
0.01u
B
C413
0.01u
B
C412
XX
C411
0.01u
B
C410
XX
C409
0.01u
B
C408
XX
R425
0.01u
B
C428
XX
R404
R417
XX
JL408
JL409
JL410
JL411
JL412
10k
R423
XX
C427
0.01u
B
C415
0.01u
B
C417
YOUT
Y/G
CB/R
CR/B
COUT
COMPOUT
0
R402
16V
10u
C402
16V
10u
C406
50V
1u
C404
0.01u
B
C403
4V
220u
C405
16V
10u
C401
0
R401
+5V
1200
R414
6800
R413
0.1u
B
C419
0.1u
B
C420
1k
RV401
0.5%
R407
220
0.5%
R406
220
0.5%
R408
220
0.5%
R409
220
0.5%
R410
220
0.5%
R411
220
DVD4
DVD7
DVD0
DVD2
DVD6
DVD1
DVD5
DVD3
27MCLK
100
R405
0.01u
B
C407
XFRRST
R416
XX
R420
XX
XX
R415
33MAVD
XX
R429
XX
R418
XX
R421
JL404
JL403
JL405
JL406
JL413
JL407
JL414
JL415
JL417
JL416
0.01u
B
C449
FL402
FL403
R436
XX
R437
XX
R438
XX
0
R439
TK11118CS
IC401
1
2
3
4
5
MM1385ENLE
IC402
1
2
3
4
5
XX
C450
IC403
CXD1935Q
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104
105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120 121 122 123 124 125 126 127 128 129 130 131 132 133 134 135 136 137 138 139 140 141 142 143 144
44
52
43
51
42
50
41
49
40
48
39
47
38
46
37
45
145 146 147 148 149 150 151 152 153 154 155 156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
470
R403
ADDT6
ADDT7
ADDT12
ADDT5
ADDT1
ADDT2
ADDT0
ADDT14
ADDT14
ADDT13
ADDT3
ADDT8
ADDT15
ADDT11
ADDT10
ADDT9
DQML
DQMU
XWE
XCAS
CLK
XRAS
CKE
XCS2
XCS
ADAD11
ADAD9
ADAD10
ADAD8
ADAD0
ADAD7
ADAD6
ADAD1
ADAD2
ADAD5
ADAD3
ADAD4
XFRRST
SDI4
SDI5
SDI6
SDI7
SDI0
SDI1
SDI2
SDI3
HD0
HD15
HD14
HD13
HD12
HD11
HD10
HD1
HD9
HD8
HD7
HD6
HD5
HD4
HD3
HD2
HA1
HA2
HA3
HA4
HA5
HA6
HA7
HA8
HA9
HA10
HA11
HA12
HA13
HA14
HA15
HA16
HA17
HA18
HA19
HA20
HA21
HA0
DVD7
DVD6
DVD5
DVD4
DVD3
DVD2
DVD1
DVD0
HA1
HA2
HA3
HA4
HA5
HA6
HA7
HA8
HA9
HA10
HA11
HA12
HA13
HA14
HA15
HA16
HA17
HA18
HA19
HA20
HA21
HD0
HD1
HD2
HD3
HD4
HD5
HD6
HD7
HD8
HD9
HD10
HD11
HD12
HD13
HD14
HD15
SDI0
SDI1
SDI2
SDI3
SDI4
SDI5
SDI6
SDI7
DVD0
DVD1
DVD2
DVD3
DVD4
DVD5
DVD6
DVD7
HA0
SDAD11O
CVD07
HAD14I
CVD03
SDDQ4
SDDQ1
DT5I
DO
ACH56O
IVALIn
HAD18I
IOVSS07
DVO4
TDI
CVD01
DVSS33
HAD22I
SDRASOn
COUT
SDCS1On
IOVDD12
IOVSS01
CVD06
TRST
CDBCKI
SDAD5O
TCK
MBIST_EN
BF_ID
HAD5I
DMACK1In
IOVDD00
SDDQ0
HAD3I
HCPUMDI
ICLKI
HRWn
DT0I
HAD7I
SDDQM1O
SDCS0On
YOUT
HSYNCOn
I2C_DATA
SDDQ13
HAD15I
DVO1
IOVSS03
ROUT
IOVDD09
IOVDD10
DT4I
ACH12O
BCKO
ACH34O
ISTARTIn
HAD19I
SDDQ8
DVDD33
HAD23I
AVSS02
HAD8I
CDIN1I
CVS01
SDDQ10
CVS05
SDAD2O
IOVDD05
PAVSS18G
IOVSS00
IOVSS10
CVD00
SDAD12O
CVD02
HCSn
CVS00
IOVSS13
SDDQM0O
AVSS00
CVS03
IOVDD04
SDDQ2
IOVSS11
SCLKIN
SDAD8O
DVO2
NC
SDAD0O
IOVDD08
AVSS01
LRCKO
SDDQ12
IOVDD02
IERRIn
CVS07
SDDQ7
VGO
IOVDD11
COMPOUT
DVO5
CDIN2I
DMRQ0On
IOVSS05
SDCLKO
SDCKEO
CVD08
TMS
SDCASOn
CRPCLKI
IREFI
HAD11I
SDAD9O
DT7I
IOVSS12
HAD12I
RSTn
IOVSS08
GOUT
DSPACK0
DVO0
SDDQ5
IOVSS09
HAD16I
PAVDD18P
SDAD10O
DVO3
D1CLKO
IOVDD06
BOUT
IOVDD01
SDDQ3
DT3I
HAD20I
SDDQ9
HAD9I
SDAD4O
SDAD1O
CVS02
TESTIn
IOAVDD00
CLKI
SCAN_EN
DVO6
CVS08
DMACK0In
IOVSS02
HAD1I
HWAITOn
CVD05
DT2I
SDWEOn
IOAVSS00
IOVDD03
I2C_CLK
ACLK
DT6I
HAD0I
IOVSS06
HAD13I
IOVDD13
AVDD01
DSPACK1
SDDQ11
SDDQ14
IREQON
HAD17I
CVD04
IOVSS04
AVDD02
HAD21I
SDDQ6
HAD10I
SDAD3O
SDAD7O
CDLRKI
VREFI
TDO
SCAN_MODE
HDATA0
DVO7
HAD4I
DMRQ1On
IOVDD07
SDDQ15
HAD2I
HIRQOn
SDAD6O
DT1I
HAD6I
CVS06
AVDD00
FLDO
CVS04
TRST
TMS
TCK
TDI
TDO
VIN
NOISE
GND
CONT
VOUT
HDATA1
HDATA2
HDATA3
HDATA6
HDATA4
HDATA5
HDATA7
HDATA8
HDATA9
HDATA10
HDATA11
HDATA13
HDATA12
HDATA15
HDATA14
GND
NOISE VOUT
CONT
VIN
(2012)
(2012)
TO(6/7)
22
15 TO(3/7,6/7,
7/7)
23 TO(6/7)
TO(7/7)
24
TO(7/7)
25
19 TO(3/7)
16 TO(3/7)
TO(7/7)
26
TO(7/7)
27
NOT USE
28 TO(6/7)
29 TO(7/7)
30 TO(6/7)
TO(3/7)
18
32 TO(5/7)
TO(5/7)
33
34 TO(5/7)
NOT USE
TO(6/7)
31
20 TO(3/7)
IC403
AD DECODER
+1.8V REG
IC401
IC402
+3.3V REG
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
16
3.4
0.8
1.4
0.5
0.6
0.6
1.0
1.0
1.7
2.8
2.7
2.6
2.4
1.2
2.8
2.2
2.3
2.5
1.6
1.7
0
3.4
1.7
1.7
1.7
0
1.7
1.6
1.5
1.1
2.0
3.4
1.1
1.1
1.1
1.7
3.4
1.7
1.7
2.6
3.4
2.6
1.7
1.7
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
1.7
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
2.3
1.6
0
2.5
1.7
1.8
1.6
1.5
1.1
1.5
1.8
3.4
1.0
1.7
1.9
1.4
1.5
1.3
0.5
0.4
1.5
2.0
1.4
3.4
3.4
1.7
3.4
1.7
1.8
3.4
0
0
1.8
0.5
2.2
1.7
2.0
1.8
3.4
1.8
1.4
1.7
1.4
1.4
3.4
1.7
1.8
1.9
1.7
1.4
1.5
1.8
1.9
1.8
0.1
0.1
3.1
2.7
1.4
3.4
2.5
3.4
2.8
3.4
3.0
1.5
0.1
0.1
0.1
3.4
0.7
1.7
1.7
2.1
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.4
0.1
2.5
0.5
2.5
0.5
0.6
2.5
0.6
0.6
0.5
3.4
2.5
1.0
0.4
0.4
3.4
1.7
3.4
1.7
1.0
0.7
0.9
0.8
1.7
1.4
1.1
1.1
0.8
0
3.4
1.7
2.2
3.4
1.5
3.3
3.3
1.8
4.8
2.5
1.3
4.8
1.3
Y
PB
SIGNAL PATH
SIGNAL
VIDEO SIGNAL
AUDIO
Y/CHROMA
CHROMA
MB-103 BOARD (4/7)
AV DECODER
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK:PB MODE
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-19
4-20
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board.
SDRAM
MB-103 (5/7)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
+3.3V
GND
IC406
XX
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54
C447
0.01u
C441
0.01u
R431
XX
0.01u
B
C438
C448
XX
C444
XX
XX
C437
C440
XX
C445
XX
C442
0.01u
C443
XX
0.01u
B
C439
0.01u
B
C446
FL404
IC405
HY57V16161
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
IC404
HY57V16161
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
ADDT12
ADDT6
ADDT1
ADDT0
ADDT8
ADDT14
ADDT7
ADDT3
ADDT14
ADDT15
ADDT13
ADDT2
ADDT5
ADDT10
ADDT9
ADDT11
XWE
CKE
ADAD9
ADAD6
ADAD10
DQMU
ADAD2
CLK
XCAS
XCS2
ADAD8
DQML
ADAD3
ADAD5
ADAD1
ADAD11
ADAD0
XRAS
XCS
ADAD4
ADAD7
ADAD6
ADDT2
ADDT6
ADAD6
ADDT14
ADAD11
ADDT2
ADAD2
ADAD1
ADDT11
ADDT3
ADAD0
ADDT1
ADAD3
ADAD5
ADDT8
ADAD5
ADDT12
ADAD0
ADDT10
ADAD9
ADAD7
ADDT12
ADAD2
ADAD4
ADAD3
ADAD4
ADAD10
ADDT5
ADAD1
ADDT7
ADDT6
ADDT9
ADAD8
ADDT4
ADDT5
ADDT13
ADAD11
ADDT15
ADDT15
ADDT3
ADDT7
ADAD7
ADAD10
ADDT0
ADAD8
ADDT1
ADAD9
ADDT14
ADDT8
ADDT4
ADDT13
ADDT10
ADDT0
ADDT9
ADDT11
ADAD3
ADAD2
ADAD1
ADAD0
ADAD10
ADDT7
ADDT6
ADDT5
ADDT4
ADDT3
ADDT2
ADDT1
ADDT0
ADAD4
ADAD5
ADAD6
ADAD7
ADAD8
ADAD9
ADDT8
ADDT9
ADDT10
ADDT11
ADDT12
ADDT13
ADDT14
ADDT15
ADAD11
ADDT0
ADDT15
ADDT1
ADDT14
ADDT2
ADDT13
ADDT3
ADDT12
ADDT14
ADDT11
ADDT5
ADDT10
ADDT6
ADDT9
ADDT7
ADDT8
ADAD11
ADAD9
ADAD10
ADAD8
ADAD0
ADAD7
ADAD1
ADAD6
ADAD2
ADAD5
ADAD3
ADAD4
VCC
DQ0
DQ1
VSSQ
DQ2
DQ3
VCCQ
DQ4
DQ5
VSSQ
DQ6
DQ7
VCCQ
DQML
WE
CAS
RAS
CS
A11(BA)
A10/AP
A0
A1
A2
A3
VCC
VSS
DQ15
DQ14
VSSQ
DQ13
DQ12
VCCQ
DQ11
DQ10
VSSQ
DQ9
DQ8
VCCQ
N.C.
DQMU
CLK
CKE
N.C.
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
VSS
A1
DQ10
DQ7
A11(BA)
VSSQ
RAS
DQ4
N.C.
A0
DQ11
VSSQ
DQML
VCCQ
VCC
N.C.
VCC
CAS
A9
VCCQ
CKE
A10/AP
DQ13
A7
DQ6
VSSQ
A3
VCCQ
A5
WE
DQ14
DQ2
DQ9
DQ15
A6
DQ3
VSS
VSSQ
A2
DQ12
A4
VCCQ
A8
DQ0
VSS
DQMU
CS
DQ8
DQ1
DQ5
CLK
VDD
DQ0
VDDQ
DQ1
DQ2
VSSQ
DQ3
DQ4
VDDQ
DQ5
DQ6
VSSQ
DQ7
VDD
LDQM
WE
CAS
RAS
CS
BA0
BA1
A10/AP
A0
A1
A2
A3
VDD
VSS
DQ15
VSSQ
DQ14
DQ13
VDDQ
DQ12
DQ11
VSSQ
DQ10
DQ9
VDDQ
DQ8
VSS
N.C.
UDQM
CLK
LKE
N.C.
A11
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
VSS
32
34
33
TO(4/7)
TO(4/7)
TO(4/7)
16M SDRAM
IC404
TO(7/7)
35
16
B+
B+
B+
B+
3.3
2.1
1.7
1.8
1.8
1.9
1.7
1.0
1.9
3.3
3.3
1.9
1.8
1.6
2.1
1.8
1.9
0.1
3.0
1.4
2.6
2.8
1.0
2.4
3.3
0.1
0.1
1.5
0.1
0.7
0.1
1.7
2.1
1.5
1.4
1.5
3.3
3.3
0.1
1.9
3.3
16M SDRAM
IC405
3.3
1.7
1.8
1.0
1.7
3.3
1.9
1.9
3.3
1.8
2.1
3.3
0.1
3.0
2.6
2.4
3.0
1.5
0.1
0.1
0.7
1.4
1.5
1.5
2.1
1.8
1.5
1.9
1.9
3.3
1.8
1.0
1.9
1.6
3.3
1.5
0.1
1.4
3.3
0.1
0.1
1.7
2.1
MB-103 BOARD (5/7)
SDRAM
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK:PB MODE
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-21
4-22
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board.
• Refer to page 4-4 for waveform.
SYSTEM CONTROL
MB-103 (6/7)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
MB-103 BOARD (6/7)
SYSTEM CONTROL
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK:PB MODE
HA15
HA21
R133
0
MBM29DL324BE-90FTN
IC106
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
0.01u
B
C111
0.01u
B
C129
XWAIT
1k
R117
XAVDCS2
XWRH
R161
XX
XRST
3300
R139
XSDPIT
SO1
XX
R148
0.01u
B
C122
XAVDCS3
HA17
0.01u
B
C102
100k
R119
HD12
HA18
JL109
3300
R165
R132
0
XX
R155
XX
R154
HA12
TRMM
HA16
HA4
100
R128
DREQ1
JL108
DACK1
10k
R124
XX
R102
XX
R151
SCL
HA19
R145
XX
HA11
HD15
MA_MUTE
XX
R144
3300
R162
X101
16.5MHz
1
2
3
HD2
10k
R156
0.01u
B
C121
XX
R143
R169
22k
10k
R141
XSDPCS
XDACS
R164
2200
HA3
HA20
0.01u
B
C114
C130
XX
4V
100u
C109
HD4
100
R111
1k
R120
XX
R126
XLDON
HD7
HD14
XX
R142
HA14
10k
R123
XARPIT
100
R131
XX
R170
XX
R152
22k
R113
XDRVMUTE
+3.3V
HD6
XX
R122
HD0
HA13
CL101
0.01u
B
C108
HD1
XX
R138
HA8
XX
R146
HA7
10k
R150
100
R130
HA9
10k
R177
0.01u
B
C118
HA0
DREQ0
HA6
HD11
HD5
XAVDIT
1k
R121
XX
R125
XARPCS
SDA
+1.8V
XX
R153
XX
R147
OCSW1
HD3
XRD
HD13
XX
R149
100
R129
DACK0
R166
2200
IC108
XX
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
35 36 37 38 39 40
11
12
33 34
41 42 43 44
CKSW1
HA10
XWAIT
R127
XX
HD10
MB91307RPFV-G-BND-E1
IC104
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90
91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 111 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119 120
XX
R172
SC1
HD8
HD9
100k
R118
1k
R110
3300
R168
3300
R163
HA5
TRMP
XX
R140
XX
R109
100
R112
XX
R175
GND
HA1
XX
R101
10k
R178
HA2
BR24C64F-E2
IC101
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
B
C120
0.01u
WIDE
OCSW2
10k
R184
XX
IC107
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
35 36 37 38 39 40
11
12
33 34
41 42 43 44
JL107
TSENSD
TSENSU
IPSW
RGBSEL
DSENS
EUROVY
EXT/DSEL
R107
XX
TSENSO
JL127
0
R187
XX
R188
FL103
FL102
FL106
FL108
XX
JL128
100
R103
100
R104
100
R105
RB102
10k
1
2
3
4
5
7
8
9
10
6
RB101
XX
1
2
3
4
5
7
8
9
10
6
100
R106
FSEL
XWRH
XRD
XIFBUSY
XIFCS
XFRRST
XFRRST
SO2
SI2
SI0
SC0
SO0
HA12
HA14
HA10
HD8
HA17
HA5
HA10
HA19
HA1
HD1
HA16
HA11
HA4
HA8
HD4
HD12
HD9
HA9
HA10
HA20
HD10
HA5
HD2
HD3
HD11
HA8
HD15
HD5
HD13
HA12
HA15
SI0
HA21
HD8
HA18
HA6
HD13
HA17
HD10
HD15
HA21
HA1
HD7
HA4
HA5
HA6
HA7
HD7
HD15
HA0
HA6
HA1
HD5
HD14
HD9
HA2
HD12
HA9
HA18
SO0
HD10
HA20
HA4
HA13
HD11
HD13
HA9
HD0
HA2
HD14
HD11
HA7
HD7
HA15
HD3
HD1
HD4
HD6
HA7
HA14
HA3
HD8
HD4
HD0
HA14
HD2
HA12
HA16
HD12
SC0
HA15
HA11
HA3
HA13
HD6
HD6
HA3
HD9
HD3
HD1
HA11
HD5
HD2
HA16
HD14
HD0
HA8
HA13
HA2
HA19
SI2
SO2
SI0
SO0
SC0
XSDPIT
XARPIT
XAVDIT
IPSW
RGBSEL
TRMP
EUROVY
EXT/DSEL
FSEL
HA21
HA20
HA19
HA18
HA17
HA16
HA15
HA14
HA13
HA12
HA11
HA10
HA9
HA8
HA7
HA6
HA5
HA4
HA3
HA2
HA1
HA0
OCSW2
WIDE
TRMM
XWAIT
XDACS
HD8
HD9
HD10
HD11
HD12
HD13
HD14
HD15
HD7
HD6
HD5
HD4
HD3
HD2
HD1
HD0
IPSW
WIDE
RGBSEL
EUROVY
EXT/DSEL
DACK1
DREQ1
DACK0
DREQ0
XAVDIT
DREQ0
DACK1
XWAIT
XARPIT
XSDPIT
TSENSO
TSENSD
TSENSU
TSENSO
TSENSU
TSENSD
TRMP
OCSW2
TRMM
XDACS
FSEL
XWRH
XRD
DACK0
DREQ1
SO2
SI2
HA21
HA20
HA9
HA10
HA11
HA12
HA13
HA14
HA15
HA16
HA17
HD15
HD7
HD14
HD11
HD3
HD10
HD2
HD9
HD1
HD8
HD0
HA1
HA2
HA3
HA4
HA5
HA6
HA7
HA8
HA18
HA19
HD4
HD12
HD5
HD13
HD6
XRD
XWRH
HA8
WE
N.C.
DREQ0
MD2
HA16
DQ11
DQ15/A-1
A13
A2
VSS
CS1X
A15
VCC
DQ5
DQ13
VSS
A3
DQ6
GND
A0
BYTE
INT3
A4
CS7X
DQ14
A6
VCCI
CE
A16
HA22
48/44.1K
HD0
DQ7
VSS
HA19
A12
I/O5
HA14
SDA
I/O12
EUROVY
HA17
SCL
A0
AVCC
I/O3
GND
HA12
A7
A5
HA20
HD2
XFRRST
AVSS
XDRVMUTE
INT6
HD1
A3
SI0
AN0
CS6X
XIFCS
A4
XWAIT
HA3
CPUCK
X2
GND
A20
HA6
A17
HA1
SC1
X1
HD13
A19
TRM+
MA_MUTE
HA0
OE
OE
VSS
EXT/DSEL
HD12
XDACS
A6
A8
HA11
DQ0
INT0
AVRH
HD11
A9
INT7
WP
HA15
A10
INT4
VSS
TRM-
A11
CS2X
BGRNTX
HD15
NMIX
SC0
INT2
A12
A1
MD0
HD14
SO2
A5
HA5
VCC
DQ12
INT5
OCSW2
A11
A13
SRAMWE
XWRL
I/O11
AN1
SO1
INT1
A10
VCC
CS0X
A18
DQ9
AN2
VSS
HA4
RY/BY
DQ2
HA9
I/O14
HD8
WP/ACC
A14
HD9
DACK1
I/O2
N.C.
DACK0
A14
A15
HD4
I/O1
RESET
HA7
VCC
DSENS
OCSW1/TSW2
I/O7
HD5
I/O0
BRQ
WE
VCCI
I/O9
CS3X
LB
A1
CKSW1/TSW1
HD3
VSS
AN3
HA13
I/O10
A2
VCC
XARPRST
MD1
DREQ1
DQ8
WP
A7
SI2
DQ1
CS4X
I/O15
XRST
A9
DQ4
I/O6
A8
I/O4
RGBSEL
HD6
SI1
HD10
A2
SCL
CS5X
UB
HD7
WIDE
CS
XWRH
N.C.
N.C.
HA18
A0
SDA
HA10
I/O8
HA21
VCC
A1
XSACS
DQ10
SO0
HA2
DQ3
XRD
I/O13
VCC
D10
BYTE
A2
OE
D14
N.C.
VCC
D1
A17
D2
A16
A3
VSS
D7
A15
D4
CE
A12
A4
D5
A14
D12
HA21
A9
D15/A-1
A0
A11
D8
A5
D9
D13
A6
A13
D11
A8
D3
VSS
A1
A10
D0
D6
A18
A7
A19
(2012)
(2012)
(2012)
IC101
EEP ROM
IC104
SYSTEM CONTROL
FLASH MEMORY
IC106
36 TO(7/7)
TO(7/7)
37
TO(2/7)
8
TO(3/7,4/7,
7/7)
15
NOT USE
TO(2/7)
12
TO(4/7)
28
TO(3/7)
17
TO(7/7)
38
6
TO(1/7)
22 TO(4/7)
TO(3/7,4/7)
18
30 TO(4/7)
23 TO(4/7)
21 TO(3/7)
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
16
TO(7/7)
39
31 TO(4/7)
3.3
3.3
3.3
3.3
3.3
3.3
0
3.4
0
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
0
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.0
2.0
3.4
3.4
0
1.6
1.6
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
1.7
3.4
3.4
3.4
1.7
3.4
2.1
0
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
0
0.5
0.8
0.6
1.3
1.1
0.9
0.3
1.8
0.4
1.5
1.4
1.8
1.9
1.3
1.0
1.4
1.6
3.4
1.8
1.6
1.5
2.5
1.2
2.8
2.5
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.8
2.7
2.7
1.1
0.6
0
3.4
3.4
3.3
3.4
3.3
1.5
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.5
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.5
3.3
3.3
2.9
1.3
1.3
1.4
2.0
1.4
0.4
1.5
3.4
3.4
3.4
1
0.3
1.6
1.8
3.3
1.3
1.0
1.6
2.7
2.2
1.9
0.8
1.8
0.5
1.4
2.2
1.3
2.4
2.0
0.5
3.3
2.4
3.3
0.9
3.3
3.3
1.1
3.3
1.3
0.5
2.6
1.4
0.4
1.8
2.6
1.0
2.7
1.7
0.8
1.5
1.2
2.3
1.5
2.4
2.0
1.6
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-23
4-24
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-7 for printed wiring board.
• Refer to page 4-4 for waveforms.
AUDIO DAC, PLL
MB-103 (7/7)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
LRCK
ACH12
BCK
SC1
XDACS
SO1
XRST
SPDIF1
EXT/DSEL
RGBSEL
MA_MUTE
CR/B
EUROVY
CB/R
Y/G
YOUT
COUT
COMPOUT
WIDE
JL609
JL618
JL613
JL603
100
R601
JL602
JL615
JL601
JL614
JL604
JL619
16V
10u
C603
JL605
CXD9627N-E
IC601
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
JL617
JL610
JL611
JL606
JL607
C601
XX
JL616
0.22u
B
C602
JL621
JL612
JL608
0.01u
B
C604
JL620
R613
XX
R614
XX
IPSW
R619
XX
PR_CB/R
PR_CR/B
PR_Y/G
PR_Y
PR_C
PR_V
R621
XX
CN601
25P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
R623
XX
JL622
JL623
0uH
FB603
0uH
FB602
0
R609
0
R607
0
R608
0
R612
FB108
0uH
SM8707EV-E2
IC103
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16
100u
C126
6.3V
4V
47u
C125
FB107
0uH
JL115
22
R116
FL105
0
R160
FB111
0uH
16V
C127
47u
0
R157
JL110
XX
R135
+1.8V
100
R180
XX
C101
JL118
XX
C113
JL132
JL103
0.01u
B
C104
IC102
XX
1
2
3
4
5
FB105
0uH
M_GND
JL131
XX
C117
JL113
JL120
JL133
JL121
JL101
FB104
0uH
9P
C107
22
R134
4V
220u
C128
FL104
JL111
JL105
0
R181
XX
R179
JL134
FB109
0uH
22
R136
JL117
JL116
4V
100u
C103
9P
C106
512FSAVD
FL110
22
R137
JL112
JL102
JL135
JL130
33MARP
XX
C116
0.01u
B
C105
0
R114
FB103
0uH
0
R176
JL104
0.01u
B
C110
+5V
XX
C124
XX
R186
JL119
33MAVD
6P
CN102
1
2
3
4
5
6
FL109
X102
27MHz
FB106
0uH
XX
R158
2.2
R108
XX
C119
27MAVD
JL114
JL122
100
R183
CN101
9P
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
+11V
0
R159
10uH
L101
FL101
100
R182
JL106
XX
C112
6P
CN103
1
2
3
4
5
6
1k
R185
RFMON
JL123
JL124
JL125
JL126
JL129
FSEL
XIFBUSY
SI2
SI0
SC0
XIFCS
XFRRST
SO0
SO2
+1.8V
+3.3V
GND
+3.3V
GND
GND
+3.3V
+1.8V
GND
+3.3V
+5V
GND
+3.3V
+5V
+5V
+3.3V
GND
SO0
SC0
SI0
SO2
SI0
SI2
SC0
SO0
SO2
SI2
MCLK
BICK
SDTI
LRCK
PDN
CSN
CCLK
CDTI
DZFL
DZFR
VDD
VSS
AOUTL+
AOUTL-
AOUTR+
AOUTR-
Cr/B
WIDE
Cb/R
D_GND
Y/G
D_GND
Y
D_GND
C
DSEL
V
ISPW
D_GND
RGBSEL
ALT-
SPDIF
ALT+
P_GND_SPDIF
P_GND_AUDIO
RMUTE
ART+
LMUTE
ART-
MAMUTE
AU+5V
NOT USE
+5V
N.C.
VSS
GND
33-1OUT
XIFBUSY
VOUT
VSS
SO0
VIN
SI0
SC0
NOISE
XTI
FSEL
3.3V_MNT
GND
VDD
GND
XIFCS
512-2OUT
XFRRST
CONT
33-2OUT
+3.3V
27-2OUT
XTO
M_GND
VSS
VDD
27-1OUT
+1.8V
+11V
VDD
GND
512-1OUT
+3.3V
TXD
GND
RXD
RF MON
GND
16
36 TO(6/7)
35 TO(5/7)
TO(4/7)
26
13 TO(3/7)
7
TO(2/7)
1
TO(1/7)
2
TO(1/7)
TO(6/7)
39
TO(2/7)
10
25 TO(4/7)
TO(3/7,4/7,
6/7)
15
TO(6/7)
37
TO(3/7)
14
TO(4/7)
24
29 TO(4/7)
TO(4/7)
27
38 TO(6/7)
B TO B
TO AV-63 BOARD(1/2)
CN203
(SEE PAGE 4-27)
FOR CHECK
(SEE PAGE 4-34)
TO IF-92 BOARD
CN404
(SEE PAGE 4-33)
TO IF-92 BOARD
(CN403)
(MF-129 HARNESS)
IC601
AUDIO D/A CONVERTER
IC103
PLL
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B TO B
1.6
1.7
1.7
0
3.4
3.4
3.4
3.4
4.9
5.0
5.0
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
3
3.2
1.7
3.2
1.4
1.4
1.6
3.3
1.6
3.2
1.6
1.6
4
2
3
CHROMA
SIGNAL
PB
AUDIO
SIGNAL PATH
VIDEO SIGNAL
Y
Y/CHROMA
B+
MB-103 BOARD (7/7)
AUDIO DAC, PLL
– REF.NO.:1000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
NO MARK:PB MODE
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-25
4-26
AUDIO OUT, VIDEO OUT
AV-063
AV-63 (AUDIO OUT, VIDEO OUT) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
AV-63 BOARD
For printed wiring board
There are a few cases that the part printed on
this diagram isn’t mounted in this model.
CN103
F-15
CN202
C-14
CN203
A-6
CN204
B-8
D001
E-16
D002
D-16
D003
D-15
D101
E-9
D102
D-9
D103
D-11
D104
E-11
D201
B-2
D202
B-2
D203
B-3
D205
A-14
IC101
D-14
IC102
C-9
IC105
C-12
IC201
C-6
IC202
C-4
IC203
B-4
IC204
E-4
Q104
D-12
Q105
D-12
Q106
B-7
Q107
B-7
Q201
B-13
Q202
C-2
Q203
A-13
Q204
C-2
Q205
C-2
Q206
A-2
Q207
E-6
Q208
E-7
Q209
A-3
Q211
D-3
Q216
B-14
Q217
E-5
S101
E-13
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
13
5 4
3 2
1
Y
C
1
3
3
1
1/2
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-27
4-28
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-25 for printed wiring board.
AUDIO OUT
AV-063 (1/2)
AV-63 BOARD (1/2)
AUDIO OUT
– REF.NO.:2000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
JL222
JL204
CR/B
2SB710A-RTX
Q201
IC203
NJM78L05UA-TE1
OUT
1
GND
2
IN
3
D_GND
10k
R285
R231
47k
16V
47u
C224
Y/G
5600
R216
470
R220
16V
47u
C230
XX
C219
WIDE
XX
C241
10k
R221
470
R284
560p
C202
IPSW
100k
R218
16V
47u
C244
5P
CN204
1
2
3
4
5
UN2213-TX
Q202
V
DSEL
4700
R236
XX
R247
C
AU+11V
JL237
10k
R237
2200
R208
Y
7P
CN202
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
JL239
JL208
470
R226
JL230
JL229
CN203
25P
DTC124TKA-T146
Q204
JL232
BA4558F-E2
IC202
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
JL217
5600
R211
0.5%
JL233
0.01u
B
C226
2SB709A-QRS-TX
Q205
JL234
10k
R232
XX
R246
JL235
0
R280
C212
100p
16V
47u
C211
JL236
XX
R281
10k
R214
0.01u
B
C223
JL238
0
R282
2200
R210
XX
C243
XX
R283
100p
C213
C232
220p
470
R243
XX
R250
330u
6.3V
C242
10k
R215
J201
220k
R219
100k
R238
ET202
16V
47u
C227
R202
XX
XX
C240
0.01u
B
C214
4700
R234
JL203
2SC2712-YG-TE85L
Q203
2SB709A-QRS-TX
Q216
10k
R217
1R
CB/R
1SS355TE-17
D205
10k
R223
4700
R213
JL226
JL228
JL205
JL207
JL210
JL211
JL212
JL213
JL214
JL215
JL216
10k
R252
SW-13V
AI+5V
0
R279
D_GND
16V
47u
C210
2SD1938(F)-ST(TX).SO
Q208
2L
JL225
5600
R205
0.5%
180p
C203
XX
C217
XX
R245
P_GND
470
R227
XX
C221
2200
R209
10k
R224
50V
1u
C209
180p
C205
2200
R207
470
R242
180p
C206
XX
R244
0.01u
B
C222
220p
C216
XX
C220
4700
R235
220p
C215
2R
47k
R230
BA4558F-E2
IC201
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
XX
R203
0.5%
10k
R228
R201
XX
180p
C204
XX
C218
470
R241
47k
R225
47k
R229
5600
R212
0.5%
2SD1938(F)-ST(TX).SO
Q207
16V
47u
C228
1L
JL202
5600
R206
0.5%
TOTX178
IC204
D IN
1
VCC
2
GND
3
10k
R222
JL201
560p
C201
2SC2712-YG-TE85L
Q211
470
R240
68
R251
0.01u
B
C208
1k
R253
0.01u
B
C207
1k
R256
XX
R204
0.5%
220
R249
16V
220u
C231
1k
R254
16V
47u
C229
XX
C225
XX
R248
VMUTE
JL221
JL224
JL223
R233
10k
C233
XX
XX
C234
R239
0.5%
4700
R255
0.5%
4700
4700
R258
0.5%
4700
R257
0.5%
10k
R262
10k
R263
10k
R261
10k
R260
2SB710A-RTX
Q206
R259
XX
2SC2712-YG-TE85L
Q209
1SS355TE-17
D203
2SD1938(F)-ST(TX).SO
Q217
DAP202K-T-146
D202
1
2
3
DAN202K-T-146
D201
1
2
3
JL206
GND
A_MUTE
AI+5V
EVER+3.3V
VMUTE
AU+5V
RGBSEL
LMUTE
Y
RMUTE
WIDE
C
CB/R
SPDIF
ART+
V
P_GND_AUDIO
MAMUTE
P_GND_SPDIF
CR/B
ART-
ALT+
ALT-
DSEL
GND
-11V
+11V
MIC
MIC+ECHO
AU+11V
SW-13V
D_GND
IPSW
D_GND
D_GND
D_GND
Y/G
1
25
2
3
5
4
6
10
12
8
7
11
9
16
18
23
14
22
19
13
20
17
15
21
24
B+
OPTICAL DIGITAL OUT
IC204
BUFFER
TO(2/2)
1
TO
MB-103 BOARD(7/7)
CN601
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
DIGITAL OUT
+5V REG
IC203
B+
B+
B+
B+
B+
B-
B-
B+
B+
B+
B-
B+
B+
B-
AUDIO AMP
IC201
MUTE DRIVE
MUTE DRIVE
MUTE DRIVE
MUTE DRIVE
MUTE
DRIVE
AUDIO AMP
IC202
RCH MUTE
LCH MUTE
MUTE DRIVE
TO(2/2)
2
TO
MC-139 BOARD
CN501
(AM-130 HARNESS)
3
TO(2/2)
TO
IF-92 BOARD
CN402
(AF-122 HARNESS)
SWITCH
SWITCH
SWITCH
16
AUDIO
SIGNAL PATH
Y
SIGNAL
PB
VIDEO SIGNAL
Y/CHROMA
REC
CHROMA
(SEE PAGE 4-24)
B+
(SEE PAGE 4-37)
(SEE PAGE 4-33)
11.3
1.4
1.4
0
-10.8
1.4
1.4
0
0
0
0
0
11.3
-10.8
0.8
0
0.8
0
0.8
R
10.6
10.6
9.9
0
6.4
6.4
0.6
11.4
11.3
10.6
-11.4
-10.9
-11.5
-11.5
-12.9
-12.2
0
0.7
0.7
0.2
5.0
11.3
5.0
2.5
1.8
1.7
5.0
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-29
4-30
VIDEO OUT
AV-063 (2/2)
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-25 for printed wiring board.
• Refer to page 4-4 for waveforms.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
16V
47u
C113
R151
XX
XX
R172
XX
R140
CB/R
R149
XX
XX
D101
R147
XX
JL127
S101
XX
R144
XX
J104
P_GND
XX
R122
R143
XX
DSEL
XX
R123
XX
R120
XX
R173
R142
XX
JL119
HZM6.8ZWA1TL
D103
68
R127
XX
R159
47u
C110
16V
R139
XX
UN2111-TX
Q105
R170
XX
XX
R150
Y/G
XX
R136
XX
Q107
XX
C123
68
R131
WIDE
R137
XX
JL116
IC102
LA73050-TLM
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36
21
20
XX
R158
XX
C122
VMUTE
SW-13V
1
7
8
14
CN103
XX
Y
1
GND
2
Cb
3
GND
4
Cr
5
GND
6
N.C.
7
LINE1
8
LINE2
9
N.C.
10
LINE3
11
SW_GND
12
N.C.
13
SW
14
XX
R169
Y
AI+5V
1R
XX
R115
68
R130
HZM6.8ZWA1TL
D102
2R
JL124
UN2213-TX
Q104
1L
10k
R129
16V
47u
C102
XX
C127
JL129
XX
R171
JL123
2L
XX
IC105
1
2
3
0.047u
B
C109
XX
Q106
JL122
IC101
NJM79M05DL1A(TE2)
GND
1
IN
2
OUT
3
XX
C116
JL117
XX
R157
68
R126
68
R134
C
XX
C117
16V
47u
C126
AU+11V
XX
R146
JL126
JL120
V
100uH
L101
220p
C103
JL128
0
R162
XX
R125
JL125
D_GND
XX
R148
IPSW
CR/B
JL130
XX
D001
68
R133
ET101
XX
C128
XX
D002
XX
C124
0.1u
B
C112
XX
R152
47u
C111
16V
J101
XX
C125
0.01u
B
C101
3300
R121
XX
D104
XX
D003
0.1u
B
C114
XX
R124
68
R128
D_GND
Y
C
G
G
J103
VIDEO_IN
DCCNT1
GND
C_IN
MUTE1
Y_IN
N.C.(DCCNT2)
N.C.(GND)
Y_IN(NC)
DCCNT2
GND
Cb_IN
MUTE2
Cr_IN
+5V
VIDEO_OUT
GND
C_OUT
N.C.
Y_OUT
-5V
N.C.
+5V(NC)
Y_OUT
GND
Cb_OUT
Cr_OUT
-5V
N.C.
-5V
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
-5V
OUT
GND
IN
B+
B-
B+
B-
B+
B+
B-
B-
-5V REG
IC101
WIDE SWITCH
WIDE SWITCH
VIDEO BUFFER
IC102
TO(1/2)
1
3
TO(1/2)
AUDIO2
VIDEO1
AUDIO1
R
R
AUDIO1
L
LINE OUT
VIDEO2
AUDIO2
L
TO(1/2)
2
S VIDEO OUT
COMPONENT
VIDEO OUT
B
R
C
C
Y
16
VIDEO SIGNAL
AUDIO
SIGNAL PATH
Y
CHROMA
REC
Y/CHROMA
SIGNAL
PB
4.6
0.6
-5.0
0.2
0.2
0.6
-5.0
-5.0
0.2
4.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
3.4
0.6
1.1
3.4
0.6
0.5
1.1
-5.0
5
4
3
2
1
4.6
0
0
4.6
-12.9
-5.0
AV-63 BOARD (2/2)
AUDIO OUT
– REF.NO.:2000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-31
IF-92 (IF COM) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
IF COM
IF-092
4-32
IF-92 BOARD
CN401
D-13
CN402
E-12
CN403
C-7
CN404
B-3
CN405
B-3
CN406
B-2
D403
A-11
D404
A-11
D405
A-11
D406
A-11
D412
A-11
D413
A-13
IC403
E-10
IC404
B-9
IC405
D-10
IC406
A-12
Q401
B-11
Q402
B-12
For printed wiring board
There are a few cases that the part printed on
this diagram isn’t mounted in this model.
Q403
D-10
Q404
C-13
Q405
C-12
S401
A-1
S402
A-1
S403
A-1
S404
A-2
S405
A-4
S406
A-3
S407
A-5
S408
A-4
S409
A-5
S410
A-13
S411
A-13
S412
A-5
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
62
1
1
2
2
3
1-685-015
13
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-34
IF COM
IF-092
4-33
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-4 for waveform.
Note :
The components identified by mark
or dotted
line with mark
are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.
IF-92 BOARD (1/2)
IF COM
– REF.NO.:3000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
MA113-(TX)
D403
0.1u
B
C431
47uH
L401
MA113-(TX)
D405
2SC5053T100Q
Q402
2SC5053T100Q
Q401
0.1u
B
C422
50V
47u
C425
MA113-(TX)
D404
MA113-(TX)
D406
TMP86CK74AF-1620
IC404
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
100
R481
100
R485
100
R484
100
R483
100
R482
2700
R421
10k
R433
8200
R422
10k
R434
22k
R423
3900
R431
10k
R435
8200
R428
33
R424
0.01u
B
C420
100
R425
X401
10k
R450
0.001u
B
C421
100
R444
100k
R446
16V
100u
C411
10k
R471
XX
R472
JL408
JL410
JL409
JL407
JL405
JL404
JL403
JL402
JL401
3900
R427
2700
R430
120
R437
10k
R440
XX
R401
BZ401
XX
MA8068-L-TX
D412
0.01u
B
C409
0.01u
B
C412
XX
R410
S-80830ANUP-EDT-T2
IC405
1
2
3
R454
10k
R455
XX
XX
R470
10k
R473
10k
R448
10k
R449
XX
C408
XX
C424
XX
C415
XX
C405
XX
C406
XX
ET401
XX
ET402
XX
ET403
PS401
1.0A
XX
C433
XX
C434
0.01u
B
C432
0.01u
B
C427
JL418
JL417
JL424
JL425
JL427
JL426
JL428
JL429
JL430
0.01u
B
C407
0.01u
B
C414
0.01u
B
C416
0.01u
B
C401
JL421
JL419
JL422
JL423
JL420
JL411
JL412
JL413
JL415
JL414
JL416
FB401
0uH
10P
CN405
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
JL432
JL431
25V
220u
C419
2700
R414
0.01u
B
C437
JL406
7P
CN402
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
UN2111-TX
Q405
1800
R415
2SD1766-T100-QR
Q404
10k
R418
1800
R416
27k
R490
XX
Q403
GP1UD28SYK
IC406
1
2
3
0.01u
B
C440
25V
47u
C441
47
R496
100k
R497
XX
R498
XX
R499
XX
R488
100k
R489
XX
D413
JL433
JL434
JL435
CN403
6P
1
+1.8V
2
+5V
3
GND
4
SW +3.3V
5
+11V
6
M_GND
3900
R417
5P
CN406
1
GND
2
EVER +3.3
3
CURSOR
4
N.C.
5
N.C.
JL436
JL437
ND401
F1
1
F1
2
G1
5
G2
6
G3
7
G4
8
G5
9
G6
10
G7
11
G8
12
G9
13
G10
14
G11
15
G12
16
G13
17
P18
41
P17
42
P16
43
P15
44
P14
45
P13
46
P12
47
P11
48
P10
49
P9
50
P8
51
P7
52
P6
53
P5
54
P4
55
P3
56
P2
57
P1
58
F2
61
F2
62
3900
R426
JL452
JL451
JL450
JL449
JL448
JL447
JL443
JL442
JL441
JL440
JL439
JL438
JL453
JL445
JL446
JL444
JL454
JL455
JL456
JL457
JL458
JL459
JL460
JL461
JL462
JL463
JL464
JL465
JL466
JL467
JL468
JL469
JL470
JL471
JL472
JL473
JL474
JL475
JL476
JL477
JL478
JL479
JL480
JL481
JL482
JL483
JL484
LMS8117ADTX-1.8/NOPB
IC403
1
GND
2
VOUT
3
VIN
XX
C423
25V
22u
C426
S401
S402
S403
S404
S405
S406
S407
S408
S409
S410
S411
S412
T401
D-D CONVERTER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
25V
22u
C428
0.01u
C417
PS402
0.7A
25V
100u
C429
CN404
9P
SOO
1
GND
2
SCO
3
SIO
4
XIFBUSY
5
XIFCS
6
3.3V_MNT
7
XFRRST
8
GND
9
13P
CN401
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
R474
100
DIG12
DIG11
DIG10
DIG9
DIG8
DIG7
DIG6
DIG5
DIG4
DIG3
DIG2
SEG18
SEG17
SEG16
SEG15
SEG14
SEG13
SEG12
SEG11
SEG10
SEG9
SEG8
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SEG4
SEG3
SEG2
SEG1
DIG1
DIG13
DIG1
DIG2
DIG3
DIG4
DIG5
DIG6
DIG7
DIG8
DIG9
DIG10
DIG11
DIG12
SEG18
SEG17
SEG16
SEG15
SEG14
SEG13
SEG12
SEG11
SEG10
SEG9
SEG8
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SEG4
SEG3
SEG2
SEG1
DIG13
(OPEN/CLOSE)
VCC
GND
VOUT
XIFCS
SC0
SOO
SIO
XIFBUSY
XFRRST
3.3V_MNT
GND
IFRST
P-CONT
POWER
D_GND
D_GND
SW+3.3V
EVER+3.3V
+5V
+11V(AUDIO)
DISPLAY
(RETURN)
(TITLE)
(NEXT)
(STOP)
(PREV)
(PAUSE)
PCONT
DIG1
DIG2
DIG3
DIG4
DIG5
DIG6
DIG7
DIG8
DIG9
DIG10
DIG11
DIG12
SEG16
SEG15
SEG14
SEG13
SEG12
SEG11
SEG10
SEG9
SEG8
SEG7
SEG6
SEG5
SEG4
SEG3
SEG2
SEG1
SEG17
DIG13
N.C.
POWER
DISPLAY
PLAY
CURSOR
AN6
AVSS
O/C
PONCHK
VREF
VKK
N.c.
SEL1
SEL0
PCONT
STATUS
BUSY
VSS
XIN
XOUT
VDD
/FRRST
IR
/RST
N.C.
SELF_CHECK
/STOP
SO
SI
/SC
N.C.
/CS
N.C.
/VMUTE
N.C.
BUZ
N.C.
N.C.
SEL2
TEST
/AMUTE
PROG
N.C.
VCC
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
N.C.
M_GND
M_GND
SW+11V
SW+11V
EVER-13V
(DVD
MENU)
PICTURE MODE
V_MUTE
A_MUTE
EVER+3.3V
GND
AU+11V
AI+5V
SW-13V
SEG18
SURROUND
TO AV-63 BOARD(1/2)
CN202
(AF-122 HARNESS)
TO MB-103 BOARD(7/7)
CN102
(MF-129 HARNESS)
B+
B+
B+
B-
B+
B+
B+
B+
+1.8V REG
IC403
SWITCH
SWITCH
B-
B+
B+
B-
B+
B+
B+
B+
TO SWITCHING REGURATOR
CN201(PF-129 HARNESS)
DC/DC CONVERTER
DC/DC CONVERTER
IC406
REMOTE COMMANDER
RECEIVER
IC405
RESET
B+
B TO B
TO
MB-103 BOARD(7/7)
CN101
FOR
CHECK
FLUORESCENT INDICATOR TUBE
(PLAY)
B+
PUSH
ENTER
CURSOR
16
(SEE PAGE 4-28)
(SEE PAGE 4-24)
(SEE PAGE 4-44,46)
IC404
IF CON
(SEE PAGE 4-24)
1.8
3.4
-15.5
-23.8
-29.6
-21.0
-15.5
-32.4
-32.4
-29.6
-21.0
-26.8
-26.9
-26.9
-21.4
-12.8
-32.5
-32.4
-32.4
-18.5
0.4
3.5
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
-30.0
3.4
3.2
-12.9
-12.9
-12.2
1.4
1.6
0
3.5
0
3.3
3.5
0
3.5
3.5
3.4
3.4
3.0
1.5
3.3
3.3
3.4
1
3.4
3.5
3.5
3.5
-32.8
3.5
3.5
3.5
2.6
3.5
0
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
-0.1
-13.2
-12.9
-13.2
-0.1
2
2
3
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-35
MC-139 (MIC AMP) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
MIC AMP
MC-139
4-36
MC-139 BOARD
CN501
A-4
D501
E-1
D502
E-1
IC501
E-3
IC502
C-2
IC503
C-4
IC504
A-2
Q501
A-5
Q502
A-4
RV501
F-5
RV502
F-3
For printed wiring board
There are a few cases that the part printed on
this diagram isn’t mounted in this model.
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
3
1
1-684-353
11
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-38
MIC AMP
MC-139
4-37
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
C511
0.001u
3900
R514
10k
R512
B
C518
0.01u
10k
R515
BA4558F-E2
IC501
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
RV501
B
C512
0.01u
XX
C517
50V
2.2u
C504
330p
C507
4700p
B
C502
UDZSTE-178.2B
D501
0
R502
100uH
L501
0.01u
B
C514
XX
C509
50V
2.2u
C510
0.01u
B
C503
100
R511
100k
R507
0.01u
C508
B
NJM4556AM-TE2
IC502
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
0.01u
C515
B
0
R504
1k
R508
10k
R510
33k
R509
0
R501
J501
0.001u
C505
0
R503
MA153-TX
D502
100k
R506
0.001u
C501
M65850FP-E1
IC503
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
100k
R523
22k
R521
22k
R522
22k
R525
22k
R526
27k
R524
0.1u
B
C532
0.22u
B
C536
0.22u
B
C535
0.068u
B
C530
2200p
B
C531
0.056u
B
C527
6800p
B
C525
0.001u
B
C528
JS501
0
R527
6800p
B
C537
50V
22u
C538
16V
47u
C526
0.068u
B
C529
22k
R520
50V
22u
C524
16V
47u
C533
0.1u
B
C534
0.01u
B
C521
0.01u
B
C522
16V
47u
C520
16V
47u
C523
RV502
10k
R519
0.001u
C516
3900
R518
100p
C519
10k
R516
10k
R517
100
R505
XX
R513
0.01u
B
C513
DTC124TKA-T146
Q501
2SB709A-QRS-TX
Q502
10k
R528
10k
R529
10k
R530
47k
R531
NJM78L05UA-TE1
IC504
1
2
3
5P
CN501
1
GND
2
-11V
3
+11V
4
MIC
5
MIC+ECH0
JL501
JL502
JL503
JL504
JL505
JL506
JL507
JL508
JL509
JL510
JL511
JL512
JL513
JL514
JL516
JL517
JL518
JL515
JL519
JL520
50V
1u
C539
22k
R532
R533
330k
50V
4.7u
C506
N.C.
LPF1 IN
LPF1 OUT
OP1 OUT
OP1 IN
CC1
CC2
GND
N.C.
VCC
CLOCK
REF
OP2 IN
OP2 OUT
LPF2 IN
LPF2 OUT
IN
GND
OUT
ECHO LEVEL
MIC LEVEL
B+
B-
B-
B+
B+
MIC
MIC AMP
IC502
MIC AMP
IC501
ECHO
IC503
IC504
+5V REG
MUTE DRIVE
MUTE DRIVE
TO
AV-63 BOARD(1/2)
CN204
(AM-130 HARNESS)
SIGNAL
AUDIO
REC
SIGNAL PATH
PB
16
(SEE PAGE
4-28)
0
0
11.3
0
-10.8
0
0
11.3
0
0
0
-10.8
0
0
0
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
0.9
5.1
0.3
0.6
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
11.3
5.1
5.1
4.4
5.0
3.2
0
MC-139 BOARD
MIC AMP
– REF.NO.:4000 SERIES –
XX MARK: NO MOUNT
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
ETXNY381N2F (SWITCHING REGULATOR) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
4-39
4-40
SWITCHING REGULATOR
POWER BLOCK (ETXNY381N2F)
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
1-468-646- 11
POWER BOARD (SW REG)
(ETXNY381N2F) (K380:HK,SP)
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
HS11S1U/HS11S1F (SWITCHING REGULATOR) PRINTED WIRING BOARD
4-41
4-42
SWITCHING REGULATOR
POWER BLOCK (HS11S1U)
POWER BLOCK
(SWITCHING REGULATOR)
IF-92
(INTERFACE CONTROL)
MS-81
(LOADING)
MC-139
(MIC AMP)
MB-103
(SIGNAL PROCESS, SERVO)
AV-63
(AUDIO/VIDEO OUT)
POWER BOARD (SW REG)
(HS11S1U)(K380:TW)
1-468-645- 11
•
: Uses unleaded solder.
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-43
4-44
SWITCHING REGULATOR
POWER BLOCK (ETXNY381N2F)
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-39 for printed wiring board.
F101
2A/250V
C101
0.047u
250V
C104
0.047u
250V
L101
43mH
L102
43mH
C103
330p
C102
330p
D104
PLIN4005
D105
PLIN4005
D106
PLIN4005
D107
PLIN4005
C105
33u
400V
IC101
MIP2E3
C107
0.47u
50V
C108
47u
25V
R103
100
ZD101
RD12
R104
15
PC101
0N3171
C110
1u
50V
D102
11EFS2
R105
D103
ST03D200
C111
L103
C109
1u
50V
F203
2.5A
D204
ERA91-02
C208
1000u
10V
D203
21D004
L203
R205
2.43k
IC202
AN1431T
R223
6.89k
C209
1u
50V
R203
C203
680u
10V
R204
2.87k
PC101
0N3171
R202
2.2k
R201
100
D202
21D004
C214
470p
250V
R222
10
L202
6.8uH
C201
100u
25V
D201
ERA91-02
L205
T101
POWER
TRANSFORMER
ZD201
1ZB33
F201
1.6A
C210
R209
330
IC201
AN1431T
F202
1.6A
C301
330u
35V
C302
330P
250V
R304
10
D301
PN2Z
L201
47uH
R301
10k
R302
330
Q301
2SB1592
B+ SWITCH
R303
1.5k
C202
Q203
2SD965
B+ SWITCH
R213
10K
R214
150
R221
68
C204
470u
10V
Q202
2SD965
B+ SWITCH
R210
10
C205
0.01u
50V
R211
732
C206
22u
50V
R212
1.8k
L206
3.3uH
C215
100u
10V
C212
330u
25V
L204
Q205
2SC3311A
POWER CONT
R219
4.7k
R218
4.7K
C211
47u
25V
PD202
SLR342MC
R220
120
Q204
2SD965
B+ SWITCH
D205
RL1N4005
R215
270
R216
10k
R224
47
C207
220u
10V
R217
1.8k
PD201
SLR42VC
R206
390
L301
SW201
POWER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
POWER
P-CONT
EVER-13V
MGND
MGND
SW+11V
SW+11V
SW+3.3V
GND
GND
EVER+3.3V
SW+5V
EVER+11V
CN201 13P
SHUNT REG
IC201,202
DC CONTROL
IC100
AC IN
CN101
TO IF-92
BOARD
CN401
(SEE PAGE
4-33)
SWITCHING REGULATOR
(ETXNY381N2F) (K380:HK,SP)
Note :
The components identified by mark
or dotted
line with mark
are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
DVP-K380
4-45
4-46
For Schematic Diagram
• Refer to page 4-41 for printed wiring board.
SWITCHING REGULATOR
POWER BLOCK (HS11S1U)
Note :
The components identified by mark
or dotted
line with mark
are critical for safety.
Replace only with part number specified.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
POWER
P-CONT
EVER-13V
MGND
MGND
SW+11V
SW+11V
SW+3.3V
GND
GND
EVER+3.3V
SW+5V
EVER+11V
CN201 13P
SW201
POWER
R213
680
C314
22u
50V
R711
1.8k
Q712
DTC143ESA
C711
47u
35V
R311
1k
R622
120
D622
SLR-343MC
Q621
DTC143ESA
Q611
2SC2655
R621
390
Q311
2SD1768S
R613
220
R313
270
IC411
XC6201P352TH
C413
47u
35V
C313
47u
35V
C613
47u
35V
C513
47u
35V
D621
SLR-343VC
C511
100u
35V
L511
100uH
P511
1.5A/125V
R304
1.2k
R305
300(270-360)
R306
1.6k
D511
D1NL20U:HS11S1F
D2L20U:HS11S1U
R301
68
R303
2.2k
C301
1u
50V
IC301
AN1431T
PC101B
TLP421F
C302
10u
50V
13
11
12
10
9
8
1
2
3
5
6
D110
D1NL20U
R110
10
C111
10u
50V
PC101A
TLP421F
R113
100
C112
47u
35V
D103
0.8W
33V
C117
1u
50V
IC101
M1P2E4
L110
45
C151
100p:HS11S1F
150p:HS11S1U
2kV
C110
120u
200V
L150
(SHORT)
D
S
C
Z150
ST02D-170
T101
POWER TRANSFORMER
D211
D2L20U
D213
D1NS4/6
D221
D1NL20U
D312
D1N60
D311
D1NS4
D611
D1NS4
P611
2.0A/125V
C221
100u35V
L311
39uH
L611
10uH
C311
150u
35V
C611
330u
35V
P311
1A/125V
C223
47u
35V
C213
47u
35V
L221
100uH
C211
150u
35V
L211
10u
R212
47k
Q211
2SJ525
D313
1SS270A
R211
1.5k
FG201
TPOO370-41
C107
680p:HS11S1F
1000p:HS11S1U
250V
D104
S1WBA60
L102
18mH
C102
(OPEN)
C104
100p
250V
L101
18mH
C103
100p
250V
FG101
TP00370-41
R101
1M
R102
1M
F101
2A/250V
C101
0.22u
250V
CN101 2P
1
2
D212
0.8W
33V
HS11S1F
HS11S1F
IOG
TO IF-092 BOARD
CN401
(SEE PAGE 4-33)
SWITCHING REGULATOR
(HS11S1U) (K380:TW)
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
4-48E
MEMO
w w w
.
x i a o y u 1 6 3 .
c o m
Q Q
3 7 6 3 1 5 1 5 0
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
T E L
1 3 9 4 2 2 9 6 5 1 3
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
5-1
DVP-K380
SECTION 5
IC PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION
5-1. SYSTEM CONTROL PIN FUNCTION
(MB-103 BOARD IC104: MB91307RPFV-G-BND-E1)
Pin No.
1-5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
Pin Name
HA17-HA21
HA22
WP
XSACS
AVCC
AVRH
AVSS
AN0
AN1
AN2
AN3
INT0
INT1
INT2
INT3
INT4
INT5
INT6
INT7
VCC
SI0
SO0
SC0
SI1
SO1
SC1
SI2
SO2
DSENS
VSS
XRST
XARPRST
RGBSEL
SDA
SCL
TRM +
EUROV/Y
EXT/DSEL
MD0
MD1
MD2
DREQ0
DACK0
XDRVMUTE
DREQ1
DACK1
XIFCS
VSS
X1
X0
I/O
O
–
O
–
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
–
I
–
–
–
–
I
O
O
–
O
O
I
O
–
–
O
O
–
I/O
O
–
–
–
I
I
I
I
O
O
I
O
O
–
O
I
Function
Address bus A17 to A21
Not used
I2C EEPROM write protect output
Not used
Power supply (+3.3 V)
Reference power supply (+3.3 V)
GND
Set of mode 0
Set of mode 1
Set of mode 2
Set of mode 3 (fixed at “H”)
AV DEC Interrupt input
ARP Interrupt input
SDSP Interrupt input
Not used
IF CON interrupt input
Not used
Not used
Not used
Power supply (+3.3 V)
Serial bus 0 (data input)
Serial bus 0 (data output)
Serial bus 0 (clock output)
Not used
Serial bus 1 (data output)
Serial bus 1 (clock output)
Serial bus 2 (data input)
Serial bus 2 (data output)
Not used
GND
System reset signal output
WIDE select signal output
Not used
I2C data input/output
I2C clock output
Not used
Not used
Not used
Input of mode select 0 (fixed at “H”)
Input of mode select 1 (fixed at “L”)
Input of mode select 2 (fixed at “L”)
AV DEC DMA-REQ 0 input
AV DEC DMA-ACK 0 output
Drive mute signal output
AV DEC DMA-REQ 1 input
AV DEC DMA-ACK 1 output
IF CON chip select signal output
GND
Clock output (16.5 MHz)
Clock input (16.5 MHz)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
5-2E
Pin No.
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85-92
93-100
101
102-109
110
111-118
119
120
Pin Name
VCC
CKSW1
OCSW1
CS0X
CS1X
CS2X
CS3X
CS4X
CS5X
VCCI
CS6X
CX7X
XWAIT
BGRNTX
BRQ
XRD
XWRH
XWRL
NMIX
VCCI
VSS
XFRRST
CPUCK
OCSW2
XDACS
TRM –
48/44.1K
WIDE
MAMUTE
SRAMWE
HD0-HD7
HD8-HD15
VSS
HA0-HA7
VCC
HA8-HA15
VSS
HA16
I/O
–
I
I
O
–
O
O
O
O
–
–
–
I
I
I
O
O
–
I
–
–
I
O
–
O
–
O
O
O
–
I/O
I/O
–
O
–
O
–
O
Function
Power supply (+3.3 V)
Chuck sensor input
Tray sensor input
Chip select signal output (for external ROM)
Not used
AV DEC chip select signal output
AV DEC chip select signal output
ARP chip select signal output
SDSP chip select signal output
Power supply (+1.8 V)
Not used
Not used
Wait signal input
Test terminal (fixed at “H”)
Test terminal (fixed at “L”)
Read enable signal output
High order byte write enable signal output
Not used
Not used (Fixed at “H”)
Power supply (+1.8 V)
GND
IF CON reset signal input
CPU clock signal output
Not used
DAC (2 CH) chip select signal output
Not used
PLL FS control signal output
LD mute signal output
Audio mute signal output
Not used
Data bus D0 to D7 (16 bits only)
Data bus D8 to D15 (16 bits) and D0 - D7 (8 bits)
GND
Address bus A00 to A07
Power supply (+3.3 V)
Address bus A08 to A15
GND
Address bus A16
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-1
DVP-K380
SECTION 6
TEST MODE
6-1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The Test Mode allows you to make diagnosis and adjustment
easily using the remote commander and monitor TV. The
instructions, diagnostic results, etc. are given on the on-screen
display (OSD).
6-2. STARTING TEST MODE
Press the [TOP MENU], [CLEAR], [POWER] keys on the remote
commander in this order with the power of main unit in OFF
status, and the Test Mode starts, then “DIAG START” will be
displayed on the fluorescent display tube and the menu shown
below will be displayed on the TV screen. At the bottom of menu
screen, the model name and revision number are displayed. Last
Off at the lower right of screen indicates the information code
concerning the last power off. To execute each function, select the
desired menu and press its number on the remote commander. To
exit from the Test Mode, press the [POWER] key.
Power Off Information Code List
00: Primary Power Off
01: Power Off Request from SYSTEM CONTROL
02: Power Off by Emergency Power Off Command from
SYSTEM CONTROL
(if information is sent from SYSTEM CONTROL)
03: IF CON Judged that SYSTEM CONTROL is Faulty
04: Power Off from Diagnosis Mode of IF CON
05: Forced Power Off by the User
06: Power Off by Power Supply Voltage Monitor
Test Mode Menu
0. Syscon Diagnosis
1. Drive Auto Adjustment
2. Drive Manual Operation
3. Mecha Aging
4. Emargency History
5. Version Information
6. Video Level Adjustment
Exit: Power Key
_
Model
: DPX-16xxxx
Revision : x.xxx
Last Off: xx
### Syscon Diagnosis ###
Check Menu
0. Quit
1. All
2. Version
3. Peripheral
4. Servo
5. Supply
6. AV Decoder
7. Video
8. Audio
_
### Syscon Diagnosis ###
Diag All Check
No. 2 Version
2-3. ROM Check Sum
Check Sum = 2005
Press NEXT Key to Continue
Press PREV key to Repeat
_
6-3. SYSCON DIAGNOSIS
The same contents as board detail check by serial interface can be
checked from the remote commander. On the Test Mode Menu
screen, press [0] key on the remote commander, and the following
check menu will be displayed.
0. (Quit)
Quit the Syscon Diagnosis and return to the Test Mode Menu.
1. (All items continuous check)
This menu checks all diagnostic items continuously. Normally, all
items are checked successively one after another automatically
unless an error is found, but at a certain item that requires
judgment through a visual check to the result, the following
screen is displayed for the key entry.
For the ROM Check, the check sum calculated by the Syscon is
output, and therefore you must compare it with the specified
value for confirmation.
Following the message, press > key to go to the next item, or
. key to repeat the same check again.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-2
To quit the diagnosis and return to the Check Menu screen, press
x or [ENTER] key. If an error occurred, the diagnosis is
suspended and the error code is displayed as shown below.
Press x key to quit the diagnosis, or . key to repeat the same
item where an error occurred, or > key to continue the check
from the item next to faulty item.
Selecting [2] and subsequent items call the submenu screen of
each item. When “———” is displayed in the submenu, it means
that the test is not supported in the model.
For example, if “5. Supply” is selected, the following submenu
will be displayed.
0. (Quit)
Quit the submenu and return to the main menu.
1. (All submenu items continuous check.)
This menu checks 2 and subsequent items successively. At the
item where visual check is required for judgment or an error
occurred, the checking is suspended and the message is output for
key entry.
Normally, all items are checked successively one after another
automatically unless an error is found.
Selecting [2] and subsequent items executes respective menus and
outputs the results.
For the contents of each submenu, see “General Description of
Checking Method” and “Check Items List”.
### Syscon Diagnosis ###
3-2. EEPROM Check
Error 03: EEPROM Write/Read N
Address
: 00000001
Write Data
: 2492
Read Data
: 2490
Press NEXT Key to Continue
Press PREV key to Repeat
_
### Syscon Diagnosis ###
Check Menu
No. 5 Supply
0. Quit
1. All
2. ARP Register Check
3. ARP to RAM Data Bus
4. ARP to RAM Address Bus
5. ARP RAM Check
_
General Description of Checking Method
2. Version
(2-2)
Revision
ROM revision number is displayed.
Error: Not detected.
The revision number defined in the source file is displayed
with four digits.
(2-3) ROM Check Sum
Check sum is calculated.
Error: Not detected.
8-bit data are added up to the ROM address 0x000F0000 to
0x002EFFFF, and the result is displayed with 4-digit
hexadecimal number. Error is not detected. Compare the
result with the specified value.
(2-4)
Model Type
Model code is displayed.
Error: Not detected.
The model code read from the EEPROM is displayed with
2-digit hexadecimal number.
(2-5)
Region
Region code is displayed.
Error: Not detected.
The region code determined from the model code is
displayed.
(2-6)
M’t Check
Mount resistance is checked.
Error 22: The region code does not accord.
Check whether the region code that is deduced from model
resistance and destination resistance accords with the region
code that is deduced from region resistance value.
3. Peripheral
(3-2) EEPROM Check
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 03: EEPROM write/read discord
0x9249, 0x2942 and 0x4294 are written to the address 0x00
to 0xFF of the EEPROM and then read for checking. Before
writing, the data are saved, then after checking, they are
written to restore the contents of EEPROM.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-3
4. Servo
(4-2)
Servo DSP Check
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 12: Read data discord
0x9249, 0x2942 and 0x4294 are written to the RAM address
0x602 of the Servo DSP and then read for checking.
(4-3)
—————
Check no support.
(4-4)
RF Amp Register Check
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 13: RF Amp register write, and read data discord
Implement 8-bit shift operation of the 0x01 to the readable/
writable register of the RF Amp. If once write data do not
accord with read data, it is NG.
5. Data Supply System
(5-2)
ARP Register Check
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 08: ARP register write, and read data discord
Data 0x00 to 0xFF is written sequentially to the ARP TMAX
register (address 0xC6) and then read for checking.
(5-3)
ARP to RAM Data Bus
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 09: ARP Tt RAM data bus error
Data 0x0001 to 0x8000 where one bit each is set to 1 are
written to the address 0 of RAM (IC303) connected to the
ARP (IC302) through the bus, then they are read and
checked. In case of discord, written bit pattern and read
data are displayed. If data where multiple bits are 1 are read,
the bits concerned may touch each other. Further, if data
where certain bit is always 1 or 0 regardless of written data,
the line could be disconnected or shorted.
(5-4)
ARP to RAM Address Bus
Data write t other address read discord check
Error 10: ARP Tt RAM address bus error
Caution: Address and data display in case of an error is
different from the display of other diagnosis (described
later).
Before starting the test, all addresses of RAM (IC303) are
cleared to 0x0000.
First, 0xA55A is written to the address 0x00000, and the
address data are read and checked from addresses 0x00001
to 0x80000 while shifting 1 bit each. Next, the data at that
address is cleared, and it is written to the address 0x00001,
and read and checked in the same manner. This check is
repeated up to the address 0x80000 while shifting the ad-
dress data by 1 bit each.
If data other than 0 is read at the addresses except written
address, an error is given because all addresses were already
cleared to 0. In this check, the error display pattern is
different from that of other diagnosis; read data, written
address, and read address are displayed in this order.
However, the message uses same template, and accordingly
exchange Address and Data when reading. The following
display, for example,
shows the data 0xA55A was read from address 0x00080000 though
it was written to the address 0x00000000. This implies that these
addresses are in the form of shadow. Also, if the read data is not
0xA55A, another error will be present.
(5-5)
ARP RAM Check
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 11: ARP RAM read data discord
The program code data stored in ROM are copied to all
areas of RAM (IC303) connected to the ARP through the
bus, then they are read and checked if they accord. If the
detail check was selected initially, the data are written to
all areas and read, then the same test is conducted once
again with the data where all bits are inverted between 1
and 0. If discord is detected, faulty address, written data,
and read data are displayed following the error code 11,
and the test is suspended.
### Syscon Diagnosis ###
5-4. ARP to RAM Address Bus
Error 10: ARP - RAM Address B
Address
: 0000A55A
Write Data
: 00000000
Read Data
: 00080000
Press NEXT Key to Continue
Press PREV key to Repeat
_
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-4
6. AV Decoder
(6-2)
1935 RAM
Data write t read, and accord check
Error 14: AVD RAM read data discord
The program code data stored in ROM (IC107) are copied
to all areas of RAM (IC504, IC505) connected to the AVD
through the bus, then they are read and checked if they
accord. Further, the same test is conducted once again with
the data where all bits are inverted between 1 and 0. If
discord is detected, faulty address, written data, and read
data are displayed following the error code 14, and the test
is suspended.
During the test, OSD display becomes blank as the OSD
area is also checked.
(6-3)
1935 SP
ROM t AVD RAM t Video OUT
Error: Not detected.
The data including sub picture streams in ROM are
transferred to the RAM in AVD, and output as video signals
from the AVD.
Though OSD display becomes blank, the output of video
signals continues until the key is pressed.
7. Video Output
(7-2) Color Bar
AVD color bar command write t Video OUT
Error: Not detected.
The command is transferred to the AVD, and the color bar
signals are output from video terminals.
8. Audio Output
(8-2) ARP t1935
Data flow from supply system DRAM to SDRAM of AV
Decoder is tested.
Error 15: ARP t 1935 video NG
16: ARP t 1935 audio NG
(8-3)
Test Tone
Pink noise output
Error: Not detected.
In the models without DD output, the test tone is output
from L and R of 2-channel only, and in the models with DD
output, the test tone is output from L and R of 2-channel,
and all channels of 5.1 output.
After turning on all outputs, each time the [NEXT] key is
pressed, the output channel is switched for individual
channel checking.
Diagnosis Check Items List
2. Version Display
(2-2)
Revision
(2-3) ROM Check Sum
(2-4) Model Type
(2-5)
Region
(2-6)
M’t Check
3. Peripheral
(3-2) EEPROM Check
(3-7) ———— (Function not supported)
4. Servo
(4-2) Servo DSP Check
(4-3) ———— (Function not supported)
(4-4) RF Amp Register Check
5. Data Supply System
(5-2)
ARP Register Check
(5-3)
ARP to RAM Data Bus
(5-4)
ARP to RAM Address Bus
(5-5)
ARP RAM Check
6. AV Decoder
(6-2)
1935 RAM
(6-3)
1935 SP
7. Video Output
(7-2)
Color Bar\
8. Audio Output
(8-2) ARP t1935
(8-3)
Test Tone
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-5
Error Codes List
00: Error not detected
01: RAM write/read data discord
03: EEPROM NG
04: Flash memory clear error
05: Flash memory write error
06: Flash memory read data discord
08: ARP register read data discord
09: ARP Tt RAM data bus error
10: ARP Tt RAM address bus error
11: ARP RAM read data discord
12: Servo DSP NG
13: RF Amp NG
14: 1935 SDRAM NG
15: ARP t1935 video NG
16: ARP t1935 audio NG
1A: System call error (Function not supported)
1B: System call error (Parameter error)
1C: System call error (Illegal ID number)
20: System call error (Time out)
22: Resistor installation error
90: Error occurred
91: User verification NG
92: Diagnosis cancelled
6-4. DRIVE AUTO ADJUSTMENT
On the Test Mode Menu screen, press [1] key on the remote
commander, and the drive auto adjustment menu will be displayed.
Normally, [0] is selected to adjust DVD (single layer), CD, and DVD
(dual layer) in this order. But, individual items can be adjusted for
the case where adjustment is suspended due to an error. In this mode,
the adjustment can be made easily through the operation following
the message displayed on the screen. Which disc is currently adjusted
is displayed on the fluorescent display tube.
0. ALL
You will be asked if EEPROM data are initialized or not, and for
this prompt, select [0] and press the [ENTER] key. First, the servo
setting data in EEPROM, Emergency History and Hour Meter are
cleared to initialize. Then, [1] DVD-SL disc, [2] CD disc, and [3]
DVD-DL disc are adjusted in this order. Each time one disc was
adjusted, it is ejected, and therefore exchange the disc following the
message. You can exit the adjustment by pressing the x button. In
adjusting each disc, the mirror time is measured to check the disk
type. In the auto adjustment, whether the disc type is correct is not
checked unlike conventional models, and accordingly, take care not
to insert a different type of disc.
## Drive Auto Adjustment ##
Adjustment Menu
0. ALL
1. DVD-SL
2. CD
3. DVD-DL
4. LCD
Exit: RETURN
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-6
1. DVD Single Layer Disc
Select [1], insert DVD single layer disc, and press [ENTER] key,
and the adjustment will be made through the following steps, then
adjusted values will be written to the EEPROM.
DVD Single Layer Disc Adjustment Steps
1.
Sled Reset
2.
Disc Check Memory SL
3.
Set Disc Type SL
4.
Spdl Start
5.
Ld ON
6.
Focus Error Check
7.
Focus ON 0 with PI Level measure
8.
Auto Track Offset Adjust L0
9.
Trv Level Check
10.
Tracking ON
11.
CLVA ON
12.
Sled ON
13.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust
14.
Auto Loop Filter Offset Adjust
15.
Auto Focus Gain Adjust L0
16.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust L0
17.
EQ Boost Adjust
18.
Auto Loop Filter Offset Adjust
19.
Auto Tracking Gain Adjust
20.
RF Level Measure
21.
Jitter measure
22.
Eep Copy Loop Filter Offset
23.
All Servo Stop
2. CD Disc
Select [2], insert CD disc, and press [ENTER] key, and the adjustment
will be made through the following steps, then adjusted values will
be written to the EEPROM.
CD Adjustment Steps
1.
Sled Reset
2.
Disc Check Memory CD
3.
Set Disc Type CD
4.
Spdl Start
5.
LD ON
6.
Focus Error Check
7.
Fcs ON 1 with PI Level measure
8.
Auto Track Offset Adjust L0
9.
Trv Level Check
10.
Tracking ON
11.
CLVA ON
12.
Sled ON
13.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust
14.
Auto Loop Filter Offset Adjust
15.
Auto Focus Gain Adjust L0
16.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust L0
17.
Eq Boost Adjust
18.
Auto Loop Filter Offset Adjust
19.
Auto Track Gain Adjust
20.
Copy Adjustment Data to LCD
21.
RF Level Measure
22.
Jitter measure
23.
All Servo Stop
3. DVD Dual Layer Disc
Select [3], insert DVD dual layer disc, and press [ENTER] key, and
the adjustment will be made through the following steps, then
adjusted values will be written to the EEPROM.
DVD Dual Layer Disc Adjustment Steps
1.
Sled Reset
2.
Disc Check Memory DL
3.
Set Disc Type DL
DVD DL Layer 1 Adjust
4.
Spdl Start
5.
LD ON
6.
Fcs ON 1 with PI Level measure
7.
Auto Track Offset Adjust L1
8.
Tracking ON
9.
Clva ON
10.
Sled ON
11.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust
12.
Auto Focus Gain Adjust L1
13.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust L1
14.
Eq Boost Adjust L1
15.
Auto Track Gain Adjust L1
16.
Jitter measure
DVD DL Layer 0 Adjust
17.
Focus Jump (L1 t L0)
18.
Auto Track Offset Adjust L0
19.
Tracking ON
20.
Clva ON
21.
Sled ON
22.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust
23.
Auto Focus Gain Adjust L0
24.
Auto Focus Balance Adjust
25.
Eq Boost Adjust L0
26.
Auto Track Gain Adjust L0
27.
Jitter measure
28.
All Servo Stop
4. LCD
LCD disc is not adjusted because the adjusted data of CD are
reflected, and SACD (hybrid disc) is not adjusted because the
adjusted data of CD and DVD-DL are reflected.
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-7
6-5. DRIVE MANUAL OPERATION
On the Test Mode Menu screen, select [2], and the manual operation
menu will be displayed. For the manual operation, each servo on/
off control and adjustment can be executed manually.
In using the Manual Operation menu, take care of the following
points. These commands do not provide protection, thus requiring
correct operation. The sector address or time code field is displayed
when a disc is loaded.
1.
Set correctly the disc type to be used on the Disc Type
setting screen.
The Disc Type setting must be performed after a disc was
loaded.
The set Disc Type is cleared when the tray is opened.
2.
After power ON, if the Manual Operation was selected,
first perform “Reset SLED TILT” by opening 1. Disc Type
screen.
3.
In case of an alarm, immediately press the x button to
stop the servo operation, and turn the power OFF.
Basic operation (controllable from front panel or remote
commander)
[POWER] : Power OFF
x : Servo stop
A (Open/Close) : Stop+Eject/Loading
O : Return to Operation Menu or Test Mode Menu
> , . : Transition between sub modes of menu
[1] to [9], [0] : Selection of menu and items
Cursor [Q]/[q] : Increase/Decrease in manually adjusted value
## Drive Manual Operation ##
Operation Menu
1. Disc Type
2. Servo Control
3. Track/Layer Jump
4. Manual Adjustment
5. Auto Adjustment
6. Memory Check
0. Disc Check Memory
Exit: RETURN
0. Disc Check Memory
On this screen, the mirror time is measured and written to the
EEPROM to check the disc type. First, set a DVD SL disc and press
[1], then set a CD disc and press [2], and finally set a DVD DL disc
and press [3]. The measured mirror time is displayed respectively.
The adjustment must be executed more than once after default data
were written.
From this screen, you can go to another mode by pressing > or
. key, but you cannot enter this mode from another mode. You
can enter this mode from the Operation Menu screen only.
1. Disc Type
On this screen, select the disc type. To select the disc type, press the
number of the loaded disc. The selected disc type is displayed at the
bottom. Selecting [1] automatically selects and displays the disc
type. In case of wrong display, retry “Disc Check Memory”. Also,
opening the tray causes the set disc type to be cleared. In this case,
set the disc type again after loading.
In performing manual operation, the disc type must be set.
Disc Check
1. SL Disc Check
2. CD Disc Check
3. DL Disc Check
0. Reset SLED TILT
Disc Type
1. Disc Type Auto Check
2. DVD SL
12cm
3. DVD DL
12cm
4. CD
12cm
5. SACD
12cm
6. DVD SL
8cm
7. DVD DL
8cm
8. CD
8cm
9. LCD
8cm
0. Reset SLED TILT
EMG. 00
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-8
Once the disc type has been selected, the sector address or time
code display field will appear as shown below. These values are
displayed when PLL is locked.
Display when DVD SL 12cm disc was selected
Display when CD 12cm disc was selected
[0] Reset SLED TILT: Reset the Sled and Tilt to initial position.
(Reset the Sled only to initial position
because the Tilt mechanism is not available
in this model.)
[1] Disc Type Check:
Judge automatically the loaded disc. As the
judged result is displayed at the bottom of
screen, make sure that it is correct.
If Disc Check Memory menu has not been
executed after EEPROM default setting, the
disc type cannot be judged. In this case,
return to the initial menu and make a check
for three types of discs (SL, DL, CD).
[2] to [9]:
Select the loaded disc. The adjusted value
is written to the address of selected disc.
No further entry is necessary if [1] was
selected.
Disc Type
1. Disc Type Auto Check
2. DVD SL
12cm
3. DVD DL
12cm
4. CD
12cm
5. SACD
12cm
6. DVD SL
8cm
7. DVD DL
8cm
8. CD
8cm
9. LCD
8cm
0. Reset SLED TILT
SA.———— SI.— EMG.00
DVD SL 12cm
Disc Type
1. Disc Type Auto Check
2. DVD SL
12cm
3. DVD DL
12cm
4. CD
12cm
5. SACD
12cm
6. DVD SL
8cm
7. DVD DL
8cm
8. CD
8cm
9. LCD
8cm
0. Reset SLED TILT
TC. —:—:— EMG.00
CD
12cm
2. Servo Control
On this screen, the servo on/off control necessary for replay is
executed. Normally, turn on each servo from 1 sequentially and when
CLVA is turned on, the usual trace mode becomes active. In the
trace mode, DVD sector address or CD time code is displayed. This
is not displayed where the spindle is not locked.
The spindle could run overriding the control if the spindle system is
faulty or RF is not present. In such a case, do not operate CLVA.
[0] Reset SLED TILT: Reset the Sled and Tilt to initial position.
(Reset the Sled only to initial position
because the Tilt mechanism is not available
in this model.)
[1] LD:
Turn ON/OFF the laser.
[2] SP:
Turn ON/OFF the spindle.
[3] Focus:
Search the focus and turn on the focus.
[4] TRK.:
Turn ON/OFF the tracking servo.
[5] Sled:
Turn ON/OFF the sled servo. When PLL
is not locked (cannot be locked), the sled
servo is not turned ON. The display keeps
ON.)
[6] CLVA:
Turn ON/OFF normal servo of spindle
servo.
[7] FCS. Srch:
Apply same voltage as that of focus search
to the focus drive to check the focus drive
system.
5 Sled FWD:
Move the sled outward. Perform this
operation with the tracking servo turned
off.
% Sled REV:
Move the sled inward. Perform this
operation with the tracking servo turned
off.
Servo Control
1. LD
Off R. Sled FWD
2. SP
Off L. Sled REV
3. Focus
Off
4. TRK.
Off
5. Sled
Off
6. CLVA
Off
7. FCS. Srch
Off
0. Reset SLED TILT
SA.———— SI.— EMG.00
DVD SL 12cm
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-9
3. Track/Layer Jump
On this screen, track jump, etc. can be performed. Only for the DVD-
DL, the focus jump and layer jump are displayed in the right field.
[1] 1Tj FWD:
1-track jump forward.
[2] 1Tj REV:
1-track jump reverse.
[3] 2Tj FWD:
2-track jump forward.
[4] 2Tj REV:
2-track jump reverse.
[5] NTj FWD:
N-track jump forward.
[6] NTj REV:
N-track jump reverse.
[7] 500Tj FWD:
Fine search forward.
[8] 500Tj REV:
Fine search reverse.
[9] 10k/20k FWD: Direct search forward.
[0] 10k/20k REV: Direct search reverse.
– The following commands are valid for DVD-DL disc only –
5 (L1 t L0): Focus jump (Trk/Sled Servo OFF) forward.
% (L0 t L1): Focus jump (Trk/Sled Servo OFF) reverse.
$ (L1 t L0): Layer jump (Trk/Sled Servo ON) forward.
4 (L0 t L1): Layer jump (Trk/Sled Servo ON) reverse.
4. Manual Adjustment
On this screen, each item can be adjusted manually. Select the desired
number [1] to [0] from the remote commander, and current setting
for the selected item will be displayed, then increase or decrease
numeric value with $ key or 4 key. This value is stored in the
EEPROM. If CLV has been applied, the jitter is displayed for
reference for the adjustment.
[1] TRK. Offset:
Adjusts tracking offset.
[2] Focus Gain:
Adjusts focus gain.
[3] TRK. Gain:
Adjusts track gain.
[4] Focus Offset:
Adjusts focus offset.
[5] Focus Balance: Adjusts focus balance.
[6] L.F. Offset:
Adjusts loop filter offset.
[7] Analog FRSW: Sets select switch of analog feedback circuit.
[8] PLL Dac Gain: Adjusts D/A converter gain of PLL.
[9] EQ BOOST:
Adjusts boost amount of equalizer.
[0] GD ADJ:
Adjusts group delay amount.
Track/Layer Jump
1. 1Tj FWD
R. Fj (L1->L0)
2. 1Tj REV
L. Fj (L0->L1)
3. 2Tj FWD
U. Lj (L1->L0)
4. 2Tj REV
D. Lj (L0->L1)
5. NTj FWD
6. NTj REV
7. 500Tj FWD
8. 500Tj REV
9. 10k/20k FWD
0. 10k/20k REV
SA.———— SI.— EMG.00
DVD DL 12cm
Manual Adjustment:Up/Down
1. TRK. Offset
2. Focus Gain
3. TRK. Gain
4. Focus Offset
5. Focus Balance
6. L.F. Offset
7. Analog FRSW
8. PLL Dac Gain
9. EQ BOOST
0. GD ADJ
Adjustment: Up/Down
SA. ------ SI. -- EMG. 00
DVD SL 12cm Jitter FF
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-10
5. Auto Adjustment
On this screen, each item can be adjusted automatically. Select the
desired number [1] to [8] from the remote commander, and selected
item is adjusted automatically.
[1] Auto TRK. Offset:
Adjusts tracking offset.
[2] Auto Focus Balance: Adjusts focus balance.
[3] Auto Focus Offset:
Adjusts focus offset.
[4] Auto Focus Gain:
Adjusts focus gain.
[5] Auto TRK. Gain:
Adjusts track gain.
[6] Auto EQ
[7] Auto L.F. Offset:
Adjusts loop filter offset.
[8] Auto Group Delay
6. Memory Check
The display image is shown below and three screens in total can be
selected.
On this screen, current servo adjusted data stored in the EEPROM
are displayed. The adjusted data are initialized by pressing the
[CLEAR] key, but be careful that they are not recoverable after
initialization.
Before clearing the adjusted data, make a note of the set data. This
screen will also appear if [0] All is selected in the Drive Auto
Adjustment. In this case, default setting cannot be made.
“THR A&L” data on the second page cannot be changed if default
setting is once made.
Auto Adjustment
1. Auto TRK. Offset
2. Auto Focus Balance
3. Auto Focus Offset
4. Auto Focus Gain
5. Auto TRK. Gain
6. Auto EQ.
7. Auto L.F. Offset
8. Auto Group Delay
SA.04EF905 SI.00 EMG.00
DVD SL 12cm
EEPROM DATA 1
— DL —
CD
LCD SL
L0
L1
Focus Gain
xx
xx
xx xx
xx
TRK. Gain
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
FCS Balnce
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
Focus Bias
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
TRV Offset
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
L.F. Offset
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
EQ. Boost
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
_
UP
: Last Data
DOWN
: Next Data
CLEAR : Default Set
page.1/3
EEPROM DATA 2
— DL —
CD
LCD SL
L0
L1
RF Jitter
xx
--
xx
xx
xx
RF Level
xx
--
xx
--
--
FE Level
xx
--
xx
--
--
FE Balance
xx
--
xx
--
--
TRV.Level
xx
--
xx
--
--
TE Gain
xx
xx
--
--
--
PI Level
xx
--
xx
xx
--
_
UP
: PREV Data
DOWN
: Next Data
CLEAR : Default Set
page.2/3
EEPROM DATA 3
— DL —
CD
LCD SL
L0
L1
Analog FRSW
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
PLL Dac Gain
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
Mirror Time
xx
xx
xx
xx
xx
_ THR A&L
xx
xx
xx/xx xx
xx
UP
: PREV Data
DOWN
: First Data
CLEAR : Default Set
page.3/3
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-11
6-6. MECHA AGING
On the Test Mode Menu screen, selecting [3] executes the aging of
mechanism. First, open the tray and load a disc. Press the H key,
and the aging will start. During aging, the number of the repeat
cycle is displayed. Aging can be aborted at any time by pressing the
x key. After the operation has stopped, unload the disc and press
again the x key or the O key to return to the Test Mode Menu.
6-7. EMERGENCY HISTORY
On the Test Mode Menu screen, selecting [4] displays the information
such as servo emergency history. The history information from last
“1” up to “10” can be scrolled with $ key or 4 key. Also, specific
information can be displayed by directly entering that number with
the ten-key pad from [1] to [9].
(Emergency history code is shown separately.)
The upper two lines display the laser ON total hours. Data below
minutes are omitted.
Clearing History Information
Clearing laser hours
Press [DISPLAY] and [CLEAR] keys in this order.
Both CD and DVD data are cleared.
Clearing emergency history
Press [TOP MENU] and [CLEAR] keys in this order.
Initializing setup data
Press [MENU] and [CLEAR] keys in this order.
The data have been initialized when “Set Up Initialized” message
is displayed.
The EMG. History display screen will be restored soon.
6-8. VERSION INFORMATION
The ROM version, region code, OPT type, etc. are displayed if [5]
is selected in the Test Mode Menu. The parenthesized hexadecimal
number in the version number field indicates the checksum value of
the ROM.
* Note after Downloading
After downloading ROM data, sometimes it happens that checksum
is not the same as that of ROM data that has been downloaded.
In such a case, go back to the menu screen and select “0. Syscon
Diagnosis”, then select “1. All” in “2. Version”. If the result of this
operation does not give an agreement, it must be either Download
error or ROM error.
6-9. VIDEO LEVEL ADJUSTMENT
On the Test Mode Menu screen, selecting [6] displays color bars for
video level adjustment. During display of color bars, OSD disappears
but the menu screen will be restored if pressing any key.
6-10.IF CON SELF DIAGNOSTIC
FUNCTION
1. IF-92 BOARD (IF CON) TEST MODE
The front board test mode is the IF CON self diagnostic mode. The
IF CON can diagnose the functions of the front panel boards that
the IF CON controls. Normally, the IF CON makes a serial
communication with the SYSTEM CONTROL and operates
following the commands from the SYSTEM CONTROL, but in the
Test mode, the IF CON operates independently from the SYSTEM
CONTROL.
In the Test mode, the following functions can be checked.
1.
Button function
2.
Remote commander receiving function
3.
SYSTEM CONTROL-IF CON serial communication
4.
Click shuttle function
5.
Fluorescent display tube lighting check
Grid check
Anode check
6.
LED control function
In the Test mode, the set operates same as usual, except voltage
monitoring, communication monitoring, display of fluorescent
display tube, and LED control.
1.
The routine that monitors +3.3 V (P-CONT) of MB-103 board
is not provided.
2.
The monitoring timer for serial communication with the
SYSTEM CONTROL is not provided. The set is not placed in
the Standby mode, even if the communication with SYSTEM
CONTROL is normal.
3.
Display of fluorescent display tube (normally, display is made
following the commands from SYSTEM CONTROL)
4.
LED control (normally, control is made following the commands
from SYSTEM CONTROL)
### Mecha Aging ###
Press OPEN key
Abort : STOP key
### EMG. History ###
Laser Hours
CD
xxhxxm
DVD
xxhxxm
1.
00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
2.
00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
Select : 1-9
Scroll :UP/DOWN
(1: Last EMG.)
Exit
:RETURN
### Version Infomation ###
IF con.
Ver.x.xxx(xxxx)
Group
xx
SYScon.
Ver.x.xxx(xxxx)
Model
xx
Region
0x
Servo DSP Ver:x.xxx
AVD ucode Ver:xxxxxxxx
OPT TYPE : x LASER
Exit : RETURN
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-12
2. OPERATION OF SELF CHECK MODE
The Self Check mode is the function to conduct the basic test to the
FL display and DVD panel section.
2-1. Self Check Mode Transition Processing
At the AC Power ON after IF CON (IC404) was reset, the input to
10pin (SELF CHECK) is judged and if “Low” is entered, the main
unit transits to the Self Check mode. In this port input judgment,
the result of 3-time attempts must be same (assuming that the MB-
103 board is not connected). While pressing the [STOP] key on the
main unit with the IF CON in STANDBY mode, enter [RETURN] t
[DISPLAY] (or [SET UP]) on the remote commander, and the unit
transits to the Self Check Mode. The Self Check mode terminates
when the IF CON transits to the STANDBY mode.
2-2. Operation of Auto Self Check
When the Self Check mode becomes active at the AC Power ON or
by key input, the test display of the following steps (1) to (4) is
repeated.
(1) FLD and LED all ON (for 5 seconds)
(2) MODEL display (for 2 seconds)
(3) Version display (for 2 seconds)
(4) ROM creation date display (for 2 seconds)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-13
2-3. Each Self Check Function
Each Self Check function tests the FLD display, LED display, and
key input.
2-3-1. FLD and LED All ON
2-3-1-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• [STOP] key and [OPEN/CLOSE] key on the main unit
• [LEFT] key on the main unit and the remote commander
2-3-1-2. Operation and Display
In this mode, all LEDs except STANDBY LED and all segments of
FLD turn ON.
Example of FLD all ON
2-3-2. Main Unit Key Name Display and Key Code Display
2-3-2-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• Keys on main unit except keys transited in self check
2-3-2-2. Operation and Display
When a key on the main unit is pressed in the Self Check mode, the
name of that key is displayed on the FLD. Also, the key name display
and the key code display can be switched with the [DISPLAY] key
on the remote commander. “NOTHING” is displayed when nothing
is entered. Also, VIDEO CD, DVD, and CD segments turn on when
a communication error occurred.
FLD display (at input of [PLAY] key on the main unit)
Input
IC404: Pin No. (Signal)
Voltage [V]
Pin ej (POWER)
Pin ef (O/C)
Pin eg (PLAY)
Pin eh (DISPLAY)
Pin ed (CURSOR)
0 – 0.2
POWER
OPEN/CLOSE
PLAY
STOP
ENTER
0.6 – 0.82
TVS
PREVIOUS
–
DISPLAY
DOWN
1.16 – 1.47
PREQ
PAUSE
–
MENU
LEFT
1.8 – 2.12
–
NEXT
–
RETURN
UP
2.48 – 2.7
–
–
–
TOP MENU
RIGHT
3.3
–
–
–
–
–
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-14
Key code display (at input of [PLAY] key, Key code: 0Ah)
At input of faulty voltage
When two keys are pressed
2-3-3. Remote Commander Key Name Display and Key
Code Display
2-3-3-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• Remote commander keys except keys transited in self check
2-3-3-2. Operation and Display
When a key on the remote commander is pressed in the Self Check
mode, the name of that key is displayed on the FLD. Also, the key
name display and the key code display can be switched with the
[DISPLAY] key on the remote commander. “NOTHING” is
displayed when nothing is entered. Also, VIDEO CD, DVD, and
CD segments turn on when a communication error occurred.
Remote commander key name display (at input of [PAUSE] key)
Remote commander key code display (at input of [PAUSE] key,
Key code: 39h)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-15
2-3-4. Communication Monitoring Display
The communication state is monitored and displayed while the key
name on the main unit and the remote commander is displayed.
When the communication to the System Controller failed, VIDEO
CD, DVD, and CD segments turn on.
Communication error display (at no key input)
Communication error display (at code display without input of the
remote commander)
2-3-5. FLD Anode Test Display and SHUTTLE Click
Operation Test
2-3-5-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• [RIGHT] on the main unit and the remote commander
• SHUTTLE on the remote commander during Anode Test display
(This model does not provide JOG/SHUTTLE, and therefore use
another DVD remote commander having the JOG/SHUTTLE)
2-3-5-2. Operation and Display
The Self Check mode transits to this mode when [RIGHT] key is
entered. Only the first segment of each grid of FLD turns on, and
each time the SHUTTLE is entered, the segment of each grid is
switched in order. When SHUTTLE input is clockwise, the segment
switches in 1 t 2 t 3 direction, or counterclockwise it switches
in 3 t 2 t 1 direction. This tests whether each segment turns on
individually.
Display at the start of Anode Test
r (Input in CW direction)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-16
2-3-6. FLD Grid Test Display and SHUTTLE Click
Operation Test
2-3-6-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• [UP] on the main unit and the remote commander
• SHUTTLE on the remote commander during Grid Test display
(This model does not provide JOG/SHUTTLE, and therefore use
another DVD remote commander having the JOG/SHUTTLE)
2-3-6-2. Operation and Display
The Self Check mode transits to this mode when [UP] key is entered.
The first grid of FLD all turns on and other grids turn off. Each time
the SHUTTLE is entered, the grid is switched in order. When
SHUTTLE input is clockwise, the grid switches in 1 t 2 t 3
direction, or counterclockwise it switches in 1 t 2 t 3 direction.
This tests whether each grid turns on individually.
Display at the start of Grid Test
2-3-7. LED Test Display
2-3-7-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• [DOWN] on the main unit and the remote commander
• SHUTTLE on the remote commander during LED Test display
(This model does not provide JOG/SHUTTLE, and therefore use
another DVD remote commander having the JOG/SHUTTLE)
2-3-7-2. Operation and Display
LED is switched in order by the input of JOG/SHUTTLE. Also,
LED ON/OFF is switched by the input of same key as the function
that turns on the LED concerned.
FLD display during LED Test
2-3-8. Beep Sound Test
2-3-8-1. Transition Keys in Self Check Mode
• Input of a key on main unit
2-3-8-2. Operation and Display
In the Self Check mode, each time a key on the main unit is entered,
a beep sound of 1kHz (100ms) is generated.
r (Input in CW direction)
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-17
a
f
h
g
e
r
p
n
s
c
m
d
j
k
b
ANODE CONNECTION
GRID ASSIGNMENT
(12G-1G)
13G
12G 11G 10G 9G
8G
7G
6G
5G
4G
3G
2G
1G
col
Dp
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
P11
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
P18
13G
12G
11G
10G
9G
8G
7G
6G
5G
4G
3G
2G
1G
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
a
h
j
k
b
f
m
s
g
e
n
p
r
c
d
col
col
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
Dp
www. xiaoyu163. com
QQ 376315150
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
TEL 13942296513
9
9
2
8
9
4
2
9
8
0
5
1
5
1
3
6
7
3
Q
Q
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
TEL 13942296513 QQ 376315150 892498299
http://www.xiaoyu163.com
6-18
6-11.TROUBLESHOOTING
6-11-1. Cannot Enter Test Mode
You cannot enter the Test mode when either button has been pressed
by any reason with the board assembled in the front panel. In this
state, the power does not turn on even under normal condition (the
unit is kept in standby state), and also no button is active and the
remote commander is not accepted. In this case, disconnect the MB-
103 board and AV-63 board, and with the SELF CHECK (pin 0) of
IF CON (IC404) on the IF-92 board kept in low state, supply AC,
and the IF CON self-diagnosis mode will be forcibly activated. The
IF CON (IC404) checks the SELF CHECK port only after the power
on reset (only at AC supply, not in standby state). If any button is
pressed, its name is displayed on the fluorescent display tube. But,
if other than “NOTHING” is displayed though no button is pressed,
it means that any button has been pressed.
6-11-2. Faults in Test Mode (MB-103 board)
1. The test mode menu is not displayed.
1-1. Board visual check
Check that the ICs of SYSCON (IC104), ROM (IC106), AVD
(IC403), ARP & SERVO (IC301) are working correctly.
Check that outside appearance of the ICs is normal.
Check that IC pins are not short-circuited.
Check that there is no soldering error.
Check that outside appearance of the capacitors and resistors
is normal.
1-2. Power supply voltage check
Check the power voltage of the power connector (CN102).
Check the power voltage of SYSCON (IC104).
Check the power voltage of ROM (IC106).
Check the power voltage of AVD (IC403).
Check the power voltage of ARP & SERVO (IC301).
If the power voltage has any abnormality t
Check that the power supply lines are not shorted.
Check that there is no soldering error.
If any abnormality cannot be found still t
Check that each IC is working normally.
1-3. Clock signal check
Measure the clock signal frequency at CPUCK (CL101) of
SYSCON (IC104) with an oscilloscope.
If the 8.25 MHz signal appears. t Check the machine
according to section 1-3-1
If the 33 MHz signal appears. t Check the machine according
to section 1-3-2.
If other frequencies are output.
R110 and R113 have defective soldering, X101 crystal
oscillator is defective.
If the measurement point is fixed to either “H” or “L”. t
Observe XFRRST (pin-uh) of SYSCON (IC104) with an
oscilloscope.
If the measurement point is “L”, check the following items.
If the IC has defective soldering, if the IC is short-circuited.
If the measurement point is “H”,
t Component X101 or SYSCON (IC104) is defective.
1-3-1. When the 8.25 MHz signal appears at CPUCK
• Check the XRD, XWRH and CS0X signal.
Observe XRD (pin-u;), XWRH (pin-ua), and CS0X (pin-tk)
of SYSCON (IC104) with an oscilloscope.
If these pins are fixed to either “L” (0V) or “H” (3.3V), or if
these pins stay in the center voltage, check the followings.
Check if the signal line does not have the defective soldering.
Check if the signal line is short-circuited with other signal
lines.
If you cannot find any problem t SYSCON (IC104) is
defective.
• HA [0 to 21] signal and HD [0 to 15] signal check
Observe HA [0 to 21] (pins-
版权声明
1. 本站所有素材,仅限学习交流,仅展示部分内容,如需查看完整内容,请下载原文件。
2. 会员在本站下载的所有素材,只拥有使用权,著作权归原作者所有。
3. 所有素材,未经合法授权,请勿用于商业用途,会员不得以任何形式发布、传播、复制、转售该素材,否则一律封号处理。
4. 如果素材损害你的权益请联系客服QQ:77594475 处理。